3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle @sc{gnu} Coreutils
9 @include constants.texi
11 @c Define new indices.
15 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
25 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
26 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options. Common options.
27 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
28 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
31 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
32 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
33 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
34 @c * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. FIXME.
35 @c * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. FIXME.
37 @dircategory Individual utilities
39 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
40 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
41 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
42 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
43 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
44 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change file permissions.
45 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners/groups.
46 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
47 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
48 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
49 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
50 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
51 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
52 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
53 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
54 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
55 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
56 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
57 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip non-directory suffix.
58 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
59 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
60 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
61 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
62 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
63 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
64 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
65 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
66 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
67 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
68 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
69 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
70 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
71 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
72 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy and change attributes.
73 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
74 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
75 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
76 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
77 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
78 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
79 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
80 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
81 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
82 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
83 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
84 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
85 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
86 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
87 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
88 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
89 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
90 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
91 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
92 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
93 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
94 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
95 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
96 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
97 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
98 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
99 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
100 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
101 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
102 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
103 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
104 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
105 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into fixed-size pieces.
106 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
107 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
108 * su: (coreutils)su invocation. Modify user and group ID.
109 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
110 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory and disk.
111 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
112 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
113 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
114 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
115 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
116 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
117 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
118 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
119 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
120 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
121 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
122 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
123 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
124 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
125 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
126 * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. Print uptime and load.
127 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
128 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
129 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
130 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
131 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
132 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
136 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the @sc{gnu} core
137 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
139 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-1996, 2000-2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
142 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
143 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
144 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
145 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
146 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
147 Free Documentation License''.
152 @title @sc{gnu} @code{Coreutils}
153 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
154 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
155 @author David MacKenzie et al.
158 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
170 @cindex core utilities
171 @cindex text utilities
172 @cindex shell utilities
173 @cindex file utilities
176 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors.
177 * Common options:: Common options.
178 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od
179 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
180 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
181 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum md5sum sha1sum sha2
182 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
183 * Operating on fields within a line:: cut paste join
184 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
185 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
186 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
187 * Special file types:: ln mkdir rmdir mkfifo mknod
188 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
189 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync truncate
190 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
191 * Conditions:: false true test expr
193 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk
194 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
195 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
196 * System context:: date uname hostname hostid uptime
197 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup su timeout
198 * Process control:: kill
200 * Numeric operations:: factor seq
201 * File permissions:: Access modes.
202 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
203 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy.
204 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual.
205 * Concept index:: General index.
208 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
212 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
213 * Backup options:: Backup options
214 * Block size:: Block size
215 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
216 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
217 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
218 * Target directory:: Target directory
219 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
220 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
221 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
222 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
224 Output of entire files
226 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
227 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
228 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
229 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
230 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
232 Formatting file contents
234 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
235 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
236 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
238 Output of parts of files
240 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
241 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
242 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
243 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
247 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
248 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
249 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
250 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
251 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
252 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
254 Operating on sorted files
256 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
257 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
258 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
259 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
260 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
261 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
263 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
265 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
266 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
267 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
268 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
269 * Compatibility in ptx:: The @acronym{GNU} extensions to @command{ptx}
271 Operating on fields within a line
273 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
274 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
275 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
277 Operating on characters
279 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
280 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
281 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
283 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
285 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
286 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
287 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
291 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
292 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
293 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
294 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
296 @command{ls}: List directory contents
298 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
299 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
300 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
301 * More details about version sort:: More details about version sort
302 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
303 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
307 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
308 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
309 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
310 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
311 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
312 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
316 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
317 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
318 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
319 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
320 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
321 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link
322 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
323 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
325 Changing file attributes
327 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
328 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
329 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
330 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
334 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
335 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
336 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
337 * sync invocation:: Synchronize data on disk with memory
338 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
342 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
343 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
344 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
348 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
349 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
350 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
351 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
353 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
355 * File type tests:: File type tests
356 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
357 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
358 * String tests:: String tests
359 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
361 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
363 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
364 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
365 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
366 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
370 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
372 File name manipulation
374 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
375 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
376 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability
380 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
381 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
382 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
383 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
385 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
387 * Control:: Control settings
388 * Input:: Input settings
389 * Output:: Output settings
390 * Local:: Local settings
391 * Combination:: Combination settings
392 * Characters:: Special characters
393 * Special:: Special settings
397 * id invocation:: Print user identity
398 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
399 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
400 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
401 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
402 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
406 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
407 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
408 * uname invocation:: Print system information
409 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
410 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier
411 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
413 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
415 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
416 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
417 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
418 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
419 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
420 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
421 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
422 * Examples of date:: Examples.
424 Modified command invocation
426 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
427 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
428 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
429 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
430 * su invocation:: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
431 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
435 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
439 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
443 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
444 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
448 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits.
449 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits.
450 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers.
451 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
455 * General date syntax:: Common rules.
456 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994.
457 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm.
458 * Time zone items:: @sc{est}, @sc{pdt}, @sc{gmt}.
459 * Day of week items:: Monday and others.
460 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago.
461 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440.
462 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502.
463 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0".
464 * Authors of get_date:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
466 Opening the software toolbox
468 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
469 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
470 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
471 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
472 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
473 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
474 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
478 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual.
485 @chapter Introduction
487 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
488 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
489 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire @sc{gnu} community
492 @cindex @acronym{POSIX}
493 The @sc{gnu} utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
494 @acronym{POSIX} standard.
495 @cindex bugs, reporting
496 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}. Remember
497 to include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
498 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
499 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong. Diffs are welcome, but
500 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
501 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
507 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
510 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
511 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
512 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
513 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
514 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
515 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
516 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
517 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
518 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
519 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
520 insights to the overall process.
523 @chapter Common options
527 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
530 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
531 @cindex backups, making
532 @xref{Backup options}.
533 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
536 @macro optBackupSuffix
537 @item -S @var{suffix}
538 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
541 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
542 @xref{Backup options}.
545 @macro optTargetDirectory
546 @item -t @var{directory}
547 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
549 @opindex --target-directory
550 @cindex target directory
551 @cindex destination directory
552 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
553 @xref{Target directory}.
556 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
558 @itemx --no-target-directory
560 @opindex --no-target-directory
561 @cindex target directory
562 @cindex destination directory
563 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
564 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
571 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
572 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
573 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
574 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
575 @option{--human-readable} option if
576 you prefer powers of 1024.
579 @macro optHumanReadable
581 @itemx --human-readable
583 @opindex --human-readable
584 @cindex human-readable output
585 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
586 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
587 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
588 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
591 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
592 @itemx @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}}
593 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
594 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
595 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
596 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
599 @cindex common options
601 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
602 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
603 described here. (In fact, every @sc{gnu} program accepts (or should accept)
606 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
607 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
608 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
609 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
610 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
611 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
612 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
614 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
615 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
616 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
617 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
618 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
619 specify a command that itself contains options.
621 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
622 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument.
629 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
633 @cindex version number, finding
634 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
638 @cindex option delimiter
639 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
640 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
641 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
645 @cindex standard input
646 @cindex standard output
647 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
648 stands for standard input, or for standard output if that is clear from
649 the context. For example, @samp{sort -} reads from standard input,
650 and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}, and @samp{tee -} writes an
651 extra copy of its input to standard output. Unless otherwise
652 specified, @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
656 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
657 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
658 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
659 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals using the --signal option.
660 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
661 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
662 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
663 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
664 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
665 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
666 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @command{eval}, @dots{}
667 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the @acronym{POSIX} standard.
675 An exit status of zero indicates success,
676 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
679 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
680 that can be used to change how other commands work.
681 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
682 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
683 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as @acronym{POSIX}
684 requires only that it be nonzero.
686 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
687 other exit status values and a few associate different
688 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
689 Here are some of the exceptions:
690 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr},
691 @command{nice}, @command{nohup}, @command{printenv}, @command{sort},
692 @command{su}, @command{test}, @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
696 @section Backup options
698 @cindex backup options
700 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
701 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
702 before writing new versions.
703 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
704 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
709 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
712 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
713 @cindex backups, making
714 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
715 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
716 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
717 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
718 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
719 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
720 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
722 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
723 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
725 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
726 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
727 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
728 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
729 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
734 @opindex none @r{backup method}
739 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
740 Always make numbered backups.
744 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
745 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
750 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
751 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
752 confused with @samp{none}.
756 @item -S @var{suffix}
757 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
760 @cindex backup suffix
761 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
762 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
763 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
764 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
765 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
774 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
775 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
776 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
777 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
778 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
780 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
783 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
784 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
785 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
786 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
788 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
789 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
794 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
795 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
796 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
799 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
800 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
803 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
804 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
805 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
806 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
807 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
810 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
811 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
812 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
817 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
818 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
819 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
822 @cindex human-readable output
825 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
826 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
827 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
828 that are upward compatible with the
829 @uref{http://www.bipm.fr/enus/3_SI/si-prefixes.html, SI prefixes}
830 for decimal multiples and with the
831 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, IEC 60027-2
832 prefixes for binary multiples}.
834 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
835 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
836 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
837 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
838 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
841 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
842 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
843 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
844 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
845 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
846 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
849 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
850 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
851 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
852 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
853 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
854 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
855 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
857 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
858 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
859 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
862 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
863 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
867 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
868 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
872 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
873 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
874 @samp{k} and the IEC 60027-2 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
875 @acronym{POSIX} use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
877 @cindex megabyte, definition of
878 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
881 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
882 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
884 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
885 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
888 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
889 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
891 @cindex terabyte, definition of
892 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
895 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
896 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
898 @cindex petabyte, definition of
899 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
902 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
903 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
905 @cindex exabyte, definition of
906 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
909 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
910 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
912 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
913 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
916 @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
917 (@samp{Zi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
919 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
920 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
923 @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
924 (@samp{Yi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
929 @opindex --block-size
930 @opindex --human-readable
933 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
934 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
935 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
936 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
937 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
938 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
939 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}.
941 @node Signal specifications
942 @section Signal specifications
943 @cindex signals, specifying
945 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
946 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
947 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
948 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
949 and numbers are supported on all @acronym{POSIX} compliant systems:
955 2. Terminal interrupt.
961 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
969 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
970 numbers. All systems conforming to @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 also
971 support the following signals:
975 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
977 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
979 Continue executing, if stopped.
981 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
985 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
987 Invalid memory reference.
989 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
993 Background process attempting read.
995 Background process attempting write.
997 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
999 User-defined signal 1.
1001 User-defined signal 2.
1005 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XSI} extension
1006 also support the following signals:
1012 Profiling timer expired.
1016 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1018 Virtual timer expired.
1020 CPU time limit exceeded.
1022 File size limit exceeded.
1026 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XRT} extension
1027 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1028 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1030 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1031 @section chown and chgrp: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1032 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1033 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1034 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1035 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1036 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1038 Since the @var{owner} and @var{group} arguments to @command{chown} and
1039 @command{chgrp} may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1041 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1042 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
1043 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID?
1044 @acronym{POSIX} requires that @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1045 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1046 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID.
1047 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1048 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1049 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1050 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1051 1000---not what you intended.
1053 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp} provide a way to work around this,
1054 that at the same time may result in a significant performance improvement
1055 by eliminating a database look-up.
1056 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1057 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1061 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1065 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1066 skip the name look-up process for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1067 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1068 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1070 @node Random sources
1071 @section Sources of random data
1073 @cindex random sources
1075 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1076 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1077 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1078 make this selection.
1080 Normally these commands use the device file @file{/dev/urandom} as the
1081 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1082 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1083 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1084 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1085 cryptographically secure pseudorandom number generator.
1087 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1088 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1089 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1090 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1093 To use such a source, specify the @option{--random-source=@var{file}}
1094 option, e.g., @samp{shuf --random-source=/dev/random}. The contents
1095 of @var{file} should be as random as possible. An error is reported
1096 if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes to randomize the input
1099 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1100 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1101 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1103 Some old-fashioned or stripped-down operating systems lack support for
1104 @command{/dev/urandom}. On these systems commands like @command{shuf}
1105 by default fall back on an internal pseudorandom generator initialized
1106 by a small amount of entropy.
1108 @node Target directory
1109 @section Target directory
1111 @cindex target directory
1113 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1114 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1115 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1116 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1117 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1118 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1119 allow more fine-grained control:
1124 @itemx --no-target-directory
1125 @opindex --no-target-directory
1126 @cindex target directory
1127 @cindex destination directory
1128 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1129 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1130 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1131 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1132 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1133 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1134 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1135 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1136 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1138 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1139 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1140 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1142 @item -t @var{directory}
1143 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
1144 @opindex --target-directory
1145 @cindex target directory
1146 @cindex destination directory
1147 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1150 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1151 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1152 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1153 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1154 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1156 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1157 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1158 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1159 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1160 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1161 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1162 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1163 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1166 The @w{@kbd{--target-directory}} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1167 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1168 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1169 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1172 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1175 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1176 If you use the @sc{gnu} @command{find} program, you can move those
1177 files too, with this command:
1180 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1184 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1185 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1186 some other special characters.
1187 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1188 @sc{gnu} @command{find} and @sc{gnu} @command{xargs}:
1191 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1192 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1199 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1200 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1201 options cannot be combined.
1203 @node Trailing slashes
1204 @section Trailing slashes
1206 @cindex trailing slashes
1208 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1209 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1210 operating on it. The @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}} option enables
1213 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1214 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1215 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1216 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1217 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1218 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1219 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1220 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1221 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1222 be the default, it is required by @acronym{POSIX} and is consistent with
1223 other parts of that standard.
1225 @node Traversing symlinks
1226 @section Traversing symlinks
1228 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1230 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1231 @c FIXME: note that `du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1232 @c different meaning.
1233 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1234 option is also specified.
1235 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1237 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1238 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1239 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1241 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1242 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1243 a symlink or its referent.
1250 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is specified on the command line
1251 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1252 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1259 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1260 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1261 that is encountered.
1268 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1269 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1270 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1271 or @option{-P} is specified.
1278 @node Treating / specially
1279 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1281 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1282 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1283 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1284 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1285 legitimate uses for such a command,
1286 @sc{gnu} @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1287 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1288 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1289 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1290 @option{--preserve-option}, is safer for most purposes.
1292 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1293 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1294 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1295 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1296 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1297 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1298 interrupt them. Tradition and @acronym{POSIX} require these commands
1299 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1300 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1301 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1302 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1304 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1305 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1306 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1308 @node Special built-in utilities
1309 @section Special built-in utilities
1311 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1312 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1313 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1314 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1315 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1316 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1319 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1320 by @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2004.
1323 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1324 return set shift times trap unset}
1327 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1328 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1329 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1331 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1332 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1333 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1334 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1336 @node Standards conformance
1337 @section Standards conformance
1339 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1340 In a few cases, the @sc{gnu} utilities' default behavior is
1341 incompatible with the @acronym{POSIX} standard. To suppress these
1342 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1343 variable. Unless you are checking for @acronym{POSIX} conformance, you
1344 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1346 Newer versions of @acronym{POSIX} are occasionally incompatible with older
1347 versions. For example, older versions of @acronym{POSIX} required the
1348 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1349 fields in each input line, but starting with @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001
1350 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1351 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1354 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1355 The @sc{gnu} utilities normally conform to the version of @acronym{POSIX}
1356 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1357 different version of @acronym{POSIX}, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1358 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1359 the year and month the standard was adopted. Two values are currently
1360 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1361 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.2-1992, and @samp{200112} stands for @acronym{POSIX}
1362 1003.1-2001. For example, if you have a newer system but are running software
1363 that assumes an older version of @acronym{POSIX} and uses @samp{sort +1}
1364 or @samp{tail +10}, you can work around any compatibility problems by setting
1365 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=199209} in your environment.
1367 @node Output of entire files
1368 @chapter Output of entire files
1370 @cindex output of entire files
1371 @cindex entire files, output of
1373 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1377 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1378 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1379 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1380 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1381 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1384 @node cat invocation
1385 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1388 @cindex concatenate and write files
1389 @cindex copying files
1391 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1392 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1395 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1398 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1406 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1409 @itemx --number-nonblank
1411 @opindex --number-nonblank
1412 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1416 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1421 @opindex --show-ends
1422 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1428 Number all output lines, starting with 1.
1431 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1433 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1434 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1435 Suppress repeated adjacent empty lines; output just one empty line
1440 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1445 @opindex --show-tabs
1446 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1450 Ignored; for @acronym{POSIX} compatibility.
1453 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1455 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1456 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1457 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1462 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1463 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1464 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1465 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1466 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1467 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1468 if standard output is a terminal.
1475 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1478 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1483 @node tac invocation
1484 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1487 @cindex reversing files
1489 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1490 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1491 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1494 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1497 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1498 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1499 the record that it follows in the file.
1501 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1509 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1510 precedes in the file.
1516 Treat the separator string as a regular expression. Users of @command{tac}
1517 on MS-DOS/MS-Windows should note that, since @command{tac} reads files in
1518 binary mode, each line of a text file might end with a CR/LF pair
1519 instead of the Unix-style LF.
1521 @item -s @var{separator}
1522 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1524 @opindex --separator
1525 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1533 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1536 @cindex numbering lines
1537 @cindex line numbering
1539 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1540 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1541 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1544 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1547 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1548 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) pages; by default, the
1549 line number is reset to 1 at the top of each logical page. @command{nl}
1550 treats all of the input files as a single document; it does not reset
1551 line numbers or logical pages between files.
1553 @cindex headers, numbering
1554 @cindex body, numbering
1555 @cindex footers, numbering
1556 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1557 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1558 style from the others.
1560 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1561 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1572 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1573 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1574 length of each string cannot be changed.
1576 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1577 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1578 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1579 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1581 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1585 @item -b @var{style}
1586 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1588 @opindex --body-numbering
1589 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1590 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1591 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1592 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1598 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1600 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1602 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1603 expression @var{bre}.
1604 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1608 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1610 @opindex --section-delimiter
1611 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1612 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1613 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1614 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1615 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1617 @item -f @var{style}
1618 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1620 @opindex --footer-numbering
1621 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1623 @item -h @var{style}
1624 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1626 @opindex --header-numbering
1627 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1629 @item -i @var{number}
1630 @itemx --page-increment=@var{number}
1632 @opindex --page-increment
1633 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1635 @item -l @var{number}
1636 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1638 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1639 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1640 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1641 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1642 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1643 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1644 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1647 @item -n @var{format}
1648 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1650 @opindex --number-format
1651 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1655 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1656 left justified, no leading zeros;
1658 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1659 right justified, no leading zeros;
1661 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1662 right justified, leading zeros.
1666 @itemx --no-renumber
1668 @opindex --no-renumber
1669 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1671 @item -s @var{string}
1672 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1674 @opindex --number-separator
1675 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1676 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1678 @item -v @var{number}
1679 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1681 @opindex --starting-line-number
1682 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1684 @item -w @var{number}
1685 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1687 @opindex --number-width
1688 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1696 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1699 @cindex octal dump of files
1700 @cindex hex dump of files
1701 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1702 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1704 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1705 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1709 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1710 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1711 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1714 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1715 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1716 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1717 printed as a single octal number.
1719 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1720 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1721 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1722 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1723 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1724 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1725 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1727 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1728 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1729 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1730 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1733 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1737 @item -A @var{radix}
1738 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1740 @opindex --address-radix
1741 @cindex radix for file offsets
1742 @cindex file offset radix
1743 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1744 be one of the following:
1754 none (do not print offsets).
1757 The default is octal.
1759 @item -j @var{bytes}
1760 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1762 @opindex --skip-bytes
1763 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1764 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1765 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1766 in decimal. Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
1767 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
1768 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
1769 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
1770 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
1772 @item -N @var{bytes}
1773 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1775 @opindex --read-bytes
1776 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1777 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1779 @item -S @var{bytes}
1780 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1783 @cindex string constants, outputting
1784 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1785 least @var{bytes} consecutive @acronym{ASCII} graphic characters,
1786 followed by a null (zero) byte.
1787 Prefixes and suffixes on @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1790 If @var{n} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1793 @itemx --format=@var{type}
1796 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
1797 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
1798 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
1799 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
1800 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
1801 in the order that you specified.
1803 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
1804 of the @acronym{ASCII} character representation of the printable characters
1805 to the output line generated by the type specification.
1809 named character, ignoring high-order bit
1811 @acronym{ASCII} character or backslash escape,
1824 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
1825 newline, and @samp{nul} for a null (zero) byte. Only the least significant
1826 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
1827 Type @code{c} outputs
1828 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
1831 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
1832 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
1833 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
1834 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
1835 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
1836 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
1837 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
1850 For floating point (@code{f}):
1862 @itemx --output-duplicates
1864 @opindex --output-duplicates
1865 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
1866 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
1867 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
1868 indicate the elision.
1871 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
1874 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
1875 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
1878 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
1879 omitted, the default is 32.
1883 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
1884 @sc{gnu} @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
1885 specification options. These options accumulate.
1891 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
1895 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
1899 Output as @acronym{ASCII} characters or backslash escapes. Equivalent to
1904 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
1908 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
1912 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
1916 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
1920 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
1924 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
1928 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
1931 @opindex --traditional
1932 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
1933 accepted. The following syntax:
1936 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1940 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
1941 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
1942 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
1943 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
1944 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
1951 @node base64 invocation
1952 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data.
1955 @cindex base64 encoding
1957 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
1958 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
1959 printable @acronym{ASCII} characters to represent binary data.
1963 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1964 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1967 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
1968 The format conforms to
1969 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc4648.txt, RFC 4648}.
1971 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1976 @itemx --wrap=@var{COLS}
1980 @cindex column to wrap data after
1981 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{COLS} characters. This must be
1984 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
1985 disable line wrapping altogether.
1991 @cindex Decode base64 data
1992 @cindex Base64 decoding
1993 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
1994 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
1995 output will be the original data.
1998 @itemx --ignore-garbage
2000 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2001 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2002 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2003 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2004 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2011 @node Formatting file contents
2012 @chapter Formatting file contents
2014 @cindex formatting file contents
2016 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2019 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2020 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2021 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2025 @node fmt invocation
2026 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2029 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2030 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2031 @cindex text, reformatting
2033 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2034 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2037 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2040 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2041 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2043 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2044 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2045 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2048 @cindex line-breaking
2049 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2050 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2051 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2052 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2053 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2054 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2055 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2056 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2057 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2058 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2059 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2060 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2063 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2068 @itemx --crown-margin
2070 @opindex --crown-margin
2071 @cindex crown margin
2072 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2073 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2074 line with that of the second line.
2077 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2079 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2080 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2081 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2082 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2083 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2089 @opindex --split-only
2090 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2091 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2092 being unduly combined.
2095 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2097 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2098 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2099 between sentences to two spaces.
2102 @itemx -w @var{width}
2103 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2104 @opindex -@var{width}
2107 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75). @command{fmt}
2108 initially tries to make lines about 7% shorter than this, to give it
2109 room to balance line lengths.
2111 @item -p @var{prefix}
2112 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2113 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2114 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2115 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2116 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2117 leaving the code unchanged.
2125 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2128 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2129 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2130 @cindex merging files in parallel
2132 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2133 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2134 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2135 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2138 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2142 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2143 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2144 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2145 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2146 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2147 The text line of the header takes the form
2148 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2149 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2150 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2151 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2152 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2153 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2154 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2157 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2158 feeds produce empty pages.
2160 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2161 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2162 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2164 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2165 truncate lines in that case.
2167 The following changes were made in version 1.22i and apply to later
2168 versions of @command{pr}:
2169 @c FIXME: this whole section here sounds very awkward to me. I
2170 @c made a few small changes, but really it all needs to be redone. - Brian
2171 @c OK, I fixed another sentence or two, but some of it I just don't understand.
2176 Some small @var{letter options} (@option{-s}, @option{-w}) have been
2177 redefined for better @acronym{POSIX} compliance. The output of some further
2178 cases has been adapted to other Unix systems. These changes are not
2179 compatible with earlier versions of the program.
2182 Some @var{new capital letter} options (@option{-J}, @option{-S}, @option{-W})
2183 have been introduced to turn off unexpected interferences of small letter
2184 options. The @option{-N} option and the second argument @var{last_page}
2185 of @samp{+FIRST_PAGE} offer more flexibility. The detailed handling of
2186 form feeds set in the input files requires the @option{-T} option.
2189 Capital letter options override small letter ones.
2192 Some of the option-arguments (compare @option{-s}, @option{-e},
2193 @option{-i}, @option{-n}) cannot be specified as separate arguments from the
2194 preceding option letter (already stated in the @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2197 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2201 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2202 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2203 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain `:'
2204 @c The `info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2205 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2206 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2207 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2208 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2209 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2210 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2211 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2212 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2213 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2214 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2215 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2219 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2220 @opindex -@var{column}
2222 @cindex down columns
2223 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2224 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2225 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2226 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2227 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2228 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2229 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2230 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2231 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2232 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2233 with @option{-m} option.
2239 @cindex across columns
2240 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2241 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2242 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2245 @itemx --show-control-chars
2247 @opindex --show-control-chars
2248 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2249 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2250 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2253 @itemx --double-space
2255 @opindex --double-space
2256 @cindex double spacing
2257 Double space the output.
2259 @item -D @var{format}
2260 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2261 @cindex time formats
2262 @cindex formatting times
2263 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2264 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}; @xref{date invocation}.
2265 Except for directives, which start with
2266 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2267 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2268 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2270 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2272 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2273 @samp{2001-12-04 23:59});
2274 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2275 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the @acronym{POSIX}
2276 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2277 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2280 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2281 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2282 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2283 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2285 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2286 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2288 @opindex --expand-tabs
2290 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2291 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2292 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2300 @opindex --form-feed
2301 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2302 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2304 @item -h @var{HEADER}
2305 @itemx --header=@var{HEADER}
2308 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2309 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2310 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2312 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2313 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2315 @opindex --output-tabs
2317 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2318 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2319 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2325 @opindex --join-lines
2326 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2327 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2328 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2329 no column alignment used; may be used with
2330 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2331 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2332 to disentangle the old (@acronym{POSIX}-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2333 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2336 @item -l @var{page_length}
2337 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2340 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2341 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2342 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2343 @option{-t} option had been given.
2349 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2350 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2351 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2353 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2354 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2355 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2356 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2357 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2358 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2359 the middle blank part.
2361 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2362 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2364 @opindex --number-lines
2365 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2366 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2367 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2368 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2369 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2370 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2371 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2372 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2373 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2374 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2375 printed with single column output only. The @var{TAB}-width varies
2376 with the @var{TAB}-position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2377 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2378 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2379 The @var{TAB}-width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2380 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2381 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2382 @var{number-separator tab}. The tabification depends upon the output
2385 @item -N @var{line_number}
2386 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2388 @opindex --first-line-number
2389 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2390 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2392 @item -o @var{margin}
2393 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2396 @cindex indenting lines
2398 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2399 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2400 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2401 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2404 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2406 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2407 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2408 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2410 @item -s[@var{char}]
2411 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2413 @opindex --separator
2414 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2415 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2416 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2417 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2418 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2419 @option{-w} is set. This is a @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2422 @item -S@var{string}
2423 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2425 @opindex --sep-string
2426 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2427 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2428 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2429 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2431 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2432 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}). @option{--sep-string} with no
2433 @samp{=@var{string}} is equivalent to @option{--sep-string=""}.
2436 @itemx --omit-header
2438 @opindex --omit-header
2439 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2440 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2441 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2442 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2443 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2444 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2445 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2448 @itemx --omit-pagination
2450 @opindex --omit-pagination
2451 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2452 set in the input files.
2455 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2457 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2458 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2460 @item -w @var{page_width}
2461 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2464 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2465 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). @option{-s[CHAR]} turns
2466 off the default page width and any line truncation and column alignment.
2467 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2468 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2469 A @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2471 @item -W @var{page_width}
2472 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2474 @opindex --page_width
2475 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters. That's valid with and
2476 without a column option. Text lines are truncated, unless @option{-J}
2477 is used. Together with one of the three column options
2478 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2479 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2480 don't affect the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2481 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2482 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2483 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}. The header
2484 line is never truncated.
2491 @node fold invocation
2492 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2495 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2496 @cindex folding long input lines
2498 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2499 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2503 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2506 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2507 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2509 @cindex screen columns
2510 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2511 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2512 return sets the column to zero.
2514 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2522 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2523 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2530 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2531 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2532 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2534 @item -w @var{width}
2535 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2538 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2540 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2541 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2549 @node Output of parts of files
2550 @chapter Output of parts of files
2552 @cindex output of parts of files
2553 @cindex parts of files, output of
2555 These commands output pieces of the input.
2558 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2559 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2560 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
2561 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2564 @node head invocation
2565 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2568 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2569 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2571 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2572 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2573 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2576 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2579 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2580 one-line header consisting of:
2583 ==> @var{file name} <==
2587 before the output for each @var{file}.
2589 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2594 @itemx --bytes=@var{n}
2597 Print the first @var{n} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2598 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2599 print all but the last @var{n} bytes of each file.
2600 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{n} by 512,
2601 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2602 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2603 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
2604 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2607 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2610 Output the first @var{n} lines.
2611 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2612 print all but the last @var{n} lines of each file.
2613 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2621 Never print file name headers.
2627 Always print file name headers.
2631 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2632 @option{-@var{count}@var{options}}, which is recognized only if it is
2633 specified first. @var{count} is a decimal number optionally followed
2634 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2635 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2636 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{count}}
2637 or @option{-n @var{count}} instead. If your script must also run on
2638 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2639 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2645 @node tail invocation
2646 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2649 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2651 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2652 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2653 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2656 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2659 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2660 one-line header consisting of:
2663 ==> @var{file name} <==
2667 before the output for each @var{file}.
2669 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2670 @sc{gnu} @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2671 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2672 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2673 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2674 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2675 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2676 the @sc{gnu} @command{tac} command.
2678 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2682 @item -c @var{bytes}
2683 @itemx --bytes=@var{bytes}
2686 Output the last @var{bytes} bytes, instead of final lines.
2687 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2688 @var{n}th byte from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2689 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
2690 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2691 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2692 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{G} by 1024*1024*1024,
2693 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2696 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2699 @cindex growing files
2700 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2701 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2702 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2703 presumably because the file is growing.
2704 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2705 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2708 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2709 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2711 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2712 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2713 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2714 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2715 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file by reopening it periodically
2716 to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2718 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2719 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2720 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2722 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2723 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2724 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2725 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2726 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2727 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2728 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2729 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2732 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2733 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2735 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2736 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, the @option{-f} option is ignored if
2737 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2741 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2742 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2743 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2747 This option is useful mainly when following by name (i.e., with
2748 @option{--follow=name}).
2749 Without this option, when tail encounters a file that doesn't
2750 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
2751 never checks it again.
2753 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
2754 @opindex --sleep-interval
2755 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
2756 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
2758 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
2759 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
2760 an arbitrary floating point number (using a period before any
2763 @itemx --pid=@var{pid}
2765 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2766 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2767 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2768 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2769 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2770 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2771 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2772 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2776 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
2779 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
2780 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
2781 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
2782 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
2783 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
2784 will print a warning if this is the case.
2786 @itemx --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2787 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2788 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2789 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2790 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2791 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2792 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2793 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2794 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2795 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
2796 This option is meaningful only when following by name.
2799 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2802 Output the last @var{n} lines.
2803 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2804 @var{n}th line from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2805 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2813 Never print file name headers.
2819 Always print file name headers.
2823 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
2824 @samp{tail -[@var{count}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
2825 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
2826 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
2827 file. In the option, @var{count} is an optional decimal number optionally
2828 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
2829 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
2830 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
2832 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
2833 On older systems, the leading @samp{-} can be replaced by @samp{+} in
2834 the obsolete option syntax with the same meaning as in counts, and
2835 obsolete usage overrides normal usage when the two conflict.
2836 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
2837 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
2840 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
2841 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{count}[b]}, @option{-n
2842 @var{count}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
2843 run on hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, you can often
2844 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
2845 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
2846 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
2847 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
2849 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
2850 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the @acronym{POSIX}
2851 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
2852 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
2853 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
2854 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
2855 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
2860 @node split invocation
2861 @section @command{split}: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
2864 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
2865 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
2867 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive sections of
2868 @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input} is
2869 @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2872 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
2875 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
2876 left over for the last section), into each output file.
2878 @cindex output file name prefix
2879 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
2880 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
2881 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
2882 sorted order by file name produces
2883 the original input file. If the output file names are exhausted,
2884 @command{split} reports an error without deleting the output files
2887 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2891 @item -l @var{lines}
2892 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
2895 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
2897 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
2898 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use @option{-l
2899 @var{lines}} instead.
2902 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
2905 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
2906 @var{size} is a number which may be followed by one of these
2907 multiplicative suffixes:
2909 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
2910 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
2911 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
2912 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
2913 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
2915 and so on for @samp{G}, @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2918 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
2920 @opindex --line-bytes
2921 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
2922 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines longer than
2923 @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
2924 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
2926 @item -a @var{length}
2927 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
2929 @opindex --suffix-length
2930 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. The default @var{length} is 2.
2933 @itemx --numeric-suffixes
2935 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
2936 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters.
2940 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
2947 @node csplit invocation
2948 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
2951 @cindex context splitting
2952 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
2954 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
2955 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2958 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
2961 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
2962 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
2963 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
2964 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
2965 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
2968 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
2969 output file after it has been created.
2971 The types of pattern arguments are:
2976 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
2977 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
2978 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
2979 file once for each repeat.
2981 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
2982 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
2983 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
2984 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
2985 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
2986 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
2987 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
2989 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
2990 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
2991 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
2993 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
2994 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
2995 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
2996 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3001 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3002 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3003 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3004 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3005 original input file.
3007 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3008 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3009 that it has created so far before it exits.
3011 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3015 @item -f @var{prefix}
3016 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3019 @cindex output file name prefix
3020 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3022 @item -b @var{suffix}
3023 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
3026 @cindex output file name suffix
3027 Use @var{suffix} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3028 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3029 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3030 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
3031 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3032 binary integer argument to readable form; thus, only @samp{d}, @samp{i},
3033 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3034 entire @var{suffix} is given (with the current output file number) to
3035 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3036 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3037 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3039 @item -n @var{digits}
3040 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3043 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3044 long instead of the default 2.
3049 @opindex --keep-files
3050 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3053 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3055 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3056 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3057 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3058 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3059 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3060 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3071 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3078 @node Summarizing files
3079 @chapter Summarizing files
3081 @cindex summarizing files
3083 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3087 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3088 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3089 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3090 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3091 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3092 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3097 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3101 @cindex character count
3105 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3106 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3107 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3110 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3113 @cindex total counts
3114 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3115 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3116 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3117 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3118 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3119 maximum line length.
3120 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3121 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3122 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3123 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3124 However, as a @acronym{GNU} extension, if only one count is printed,
3125 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3127 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3128 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3129 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3136 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3138 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3139 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3140 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths.
3142 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3150 Print only the byte counts.
3156 Print only the character counts.
3162 Print only the word counts.
3168 Print only the newline counts.
3171 @itemx --max-line-length
3173 @opindex --max-line-length
3174 Print only the maximum line lengths.
3176 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3177 @itemx --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3178 @opindex --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3179 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3180 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3181 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3182 Rather than processing files named on the command line, process those
3183 named in file @var{FILE}; each name is terminated by a null byte.
3184 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3185 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3187 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3188 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3189 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3190 One way to produce a list of null-byte-terminated file names is with @sc{gnu}
3191 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3192 Do not specify any @var{FILE} on the command line when using this option.
3194 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3196 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3197 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3200 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3201 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3209 @node sum invocation
3210 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3213 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3214 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3216 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3217 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3220 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3223 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3224 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3225 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3226 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3227 at least one file argument.)
3229 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3230 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3233 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3239 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3240 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3241 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3242 given, it has no effect.
3248 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3249 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3250 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3254 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3255 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3260 @node cksum invocation
3261 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3264 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3265 @cindex CRC checksum
3267 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3268 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3269 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3272 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3275 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3276 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3278 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3279 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3280 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3281 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3284 The CRC algorithm is specified by the @acronym{POSIX} standard. It is not
3285 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3286 previous section); it is more robust.
3288 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3294 @node md5sum invocation
3295 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3299 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3300 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3301 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3302 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3304 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3305 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3307 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3308 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3309 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3310 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered truly
3311 secure against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a
3312 given MD5 fingerprint, or modifying a file so as to retain its MD5 are
3313 considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how to produce
3314 different files with identical MD5 (a ``collision''), something which
3315 can be a security issue in certain contexts. For more secure hashes,
3316 consider using SHA-1 or SHA-2. @xref{sha1sum invocation}, and
3317 @ref{sha2 utilities}.
3319 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3320 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3321 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3322 consistent. Synopsis:
3325 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3328 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs the MD5 checksum, a flag
3329 indicating a binary or text input file, and the file name.
3330 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3331 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3332 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3333 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3334 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3336 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3344 @cindex binary input files
3345 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3346 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3347 On systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not distinguish between binary
3348 and text files, this option merely flags each input file as binary:
3349 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3350 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3351 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3355 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3356 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3357 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3358 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3359 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3360 Each valid line of input consists of an MD5 checksum, a binary/text
3361 flag, and then a file name.
3362 Binary files are marked with @samp{*}, text with @samp{ }.
3363 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3364 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3365 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3366 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3367 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3368 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3369 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3370 a warning is issued to standard error.
3371 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3372 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3373 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3374 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3375 it exits successfully.
3379 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3380 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3381 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
3382 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
3383 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
3384 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
3388 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3389 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3390 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3391 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3392 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3394 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3395 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3396 indicating there was a failure.
3402 @cindex text input files
3403 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3404 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3405 This option is the default on systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not
3406 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3407 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3414 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3415 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3416 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3424 @node sha1sum invocation
3425 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3429 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3430 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3431 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3432 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3434 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3435 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3436 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3438 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3439 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3440 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3441 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3442 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3443 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3446 @node sha2 utilities
3447 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3454 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3455 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3456 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3457 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3458 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3459 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3460 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3461 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3462 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
3463 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
3464 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
3465 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3466 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
3467 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
3468 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
3469 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3471 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
3472 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
3473 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
3474 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
3475 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}.
3476 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3478 Note: The SHA384 and SHA512 digests are considerably slower to
3479 compute, especially on 32-bit computers, than SHA224 or SHA256.
3482 @node Operating on sorted files
3483 @chapter Operating on sorted files
3485 @cindex operating on sorted files
3486 @cindex sorted files, operations on
3488 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
3491 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
3492 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
3493 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
3494 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
3495 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
3496 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
3497 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
3501 @node sort invocation
3502 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
3505 @cindex sorting files
3507 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
3508 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
3509 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
3513 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3516 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
3517 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
3524 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
3527 @cindex checking for sortedness
3528 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
3529 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
3530 exit with a status of 1.
3531 Otherwise, exit successfully.
3532 At most one input file can be given.
3535 @itemx --check=quiet
3536 @itemx --check=silent
3539 @cindex checking for sortedness
3540 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
3541 exit with status 1 otherwise.
3542 At most one input file can be given.
3543 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
3549 @cindex merging sorted files
3550 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
3551 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
3552 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
3557 @cindex sort stability
3558 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3559 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
3560 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields, in the
3561 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
3562 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
3563 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
3564 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
3565 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
3566 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
3567 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
3568 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
3569 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
3570 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
3574 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
3575 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
3576 use a non-@acronym{POSIX} locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
3577 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
3578 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
3579 environment variable to @samp{C}. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
3580 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
3581 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
3582 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
3583 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
3584 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
3586 @sc{gnu} @command{sort} (as specified for all @sc{gnu} utilities) has no
3587 limit on input line length or restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
3588 In addition, if the final byte of an input file is not a newline, @sc{gnu}
3589 @command{sort} silently supplies one. A line's trailing newline is not
3590 part of the line for comparison purposes.
3592 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
3596 0 if no error occurred
3597 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
3598 2 if an error occurred
3602 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
3603 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
3604 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
3605 the environment variable.
3607 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
3608 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
3609 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
3610 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
3611 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-@acronym{POSIX}
3612 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
3613 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
3618 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
3620 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
3621 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
3623 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
3624 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3628 @itemx --dictionary-order
3630 @opindex --dictionary-order
3631 @cindex dictionary order
3632 @cindex phone directory order
3633 @cindex telephone directory order
3635 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
3636 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
3637 By default letters and digits are those of @acronym{ASCII} and a blank
3638 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
3641 @itemx --ignore-case
3643 @opindex --ignore-case
3644 @cindex ignoring case
3645 @cindex case folding
3647 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
3648 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
3649 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3652 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
3653 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
3655 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
3657 @cindex general numeric sort
3659 Sort numerically, using the standard C function @code{strtod} to convert
3660 a prefix of each line to a double-precision floating point number.
3661 This allows floating point numbers to be specified in scientific notation,
3662 like @code{1.0e-34} and @code{10e100}.
3663 The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point character.
3664 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
3665 Use the following collating sequence:
3669 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
3671 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
3672 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
3676 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
3681 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
3682 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
3683 converting to floating point.
3686 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
3688 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
3689 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
3690 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
3692 Ignore nonprinting characters.
3693 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3694 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
3695 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
3701 @opindex --month-sort
3703 @cindex months, sorting by
3705 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
3706 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
3707 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}.
3708 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
3709 category determines the month spellings.
3710 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3714 @itemx --numeric-sort
3715 @itemx --sort=numeric
3717 @opindex --numeric-sort
3719 @cindex numeric sort
3721 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
3722 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
3723 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
3724 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
3725 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
3726 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
3727 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3730 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
3732 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
3733 To compare such strings numerically, use the
3734 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
3740 @cindex reverse sorting
3741 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
3742 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
3745 @itemx --random-sort
3746 @itemx --sort=random
3748 @opindex --random-sort
3751 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
3752 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
3753 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
3754 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
3755 except that keys with the same value sort together.
3757 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
3758 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
3759 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
3762 The choice of hash function is affected by the
3763 @option{--random-source} option.
3771 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
3772 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
3774 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
3775 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
3776 standard input to standard output.
3778 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
3780 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
3781 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
3783 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
3785 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3786 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3790 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
3791 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
3792 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
3794 Each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
3795 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
3796 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
3797 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
3798 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
3799 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
3800 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
3801 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
3802 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
3805 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
3806 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more examples.
3808 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
3809 @opindex --batch-size
3810 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
3811 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
3813 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
3814 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
3815 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
3817 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
3818 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
3819 and I/0. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
3820 requirements and I/0 at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
3823 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2.
3825 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
3826 file descriptors. Try @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf OPEN_MAX} to
3827 to display the limit for a particular system.
3828 If the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds this limit, then @command{sort} will
3829 issue a warning to standard error and exit with a nonzero status.
3831 @item -o @var{output-file}
3832 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
3835 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
3836 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
3837 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
3838 @var{output-file}, so you can safely sort a file in place by using
3839 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}.
3840 However, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
3841 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
3842 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
3843 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
3845 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3846 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
3847 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}. Portable
3848 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
3851 @item --random-source=@var{file}
3852 @opindex --random-source
3853 @cindex random source for sorting
3854 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
3855 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
3862 @cindex sort stability
3863 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3865 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
3866 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
3867 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
3870 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
3872 @opindex --buffer-size
3873 @cindex size for main memory sorting
3874 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
3875 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
3876 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
3877 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
3878 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
3879 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}. Appending
3880 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
3883 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
3884 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
3885 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
3886 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
3889 @item -t @var{separator}
3890 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
3892 @opindex --field-separator
3893 @cindex field separator character
3894 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
3895 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
3896 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
3897 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3900 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
3901 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
3902 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
3903 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
3904 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
3905 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
3906 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
3907 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
3909 To specify a null character (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) as
3910 the field separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g.,
3911 @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
3913 @item -T @var{tempdir}
3914 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
3916 @opindex --temporary-directory
3917 @cindex temporary directory
3919 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
3920 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
3921 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
3922 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
3923 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
3924 disks and controllers.
3930 @cindex uniquifying output
3932 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
3933 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
3934 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
3936 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
3938 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
3939 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
3940 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
3941 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
3942 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
3945 @itemx --zero-terminated
3947 @opindex --zero-terminated
3948 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
3949 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
3950 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
3951 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
3952 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
3953 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
3954 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
3955 or other special characters).
3959 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
3960 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
3961 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}. @sc{gnu} sort follows the @acronym{POSIX}
3962 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
3963 According to @acronym{POSIX}, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
3964 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
3965 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
3966 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
3968 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
3969 of the option letters @samp{Mbdfinr} appended to it, in which case the
3970 global ordering options are not used for that particular field. The
3971 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
3972 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
3973 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
3974 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
3975 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b},
3976 @option{-g}, @option{-M}, or @option{-n}; otherwise the varying
3977 numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
3979 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
3980 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
3981 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
3982 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
3984 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3985 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3986 On older systems, @command{sort} supports an obsolete origin-zero
3987 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
3988 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
3989 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3990 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
3991 not set by using the obsolete syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
3993 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
3994 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
3995 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
3996 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
3997 support only the obsolete syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
3998 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
4001 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
4006 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
4013 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
4014 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
4015 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
4016 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
4017 and extending to the end of each line.
4024 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
4025 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
4026 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
4029 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
4032 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
4033 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
4034 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
4035 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
4036 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
4038 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
4039 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
4040 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
4041 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
4042 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
4043 field-end part of the key specifier.
4046 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
4047 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
4048 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
4052 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4053 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
4054 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4057 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
4058 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
4059 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
4060 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
4061 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
4062 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
4063 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
4067 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
4068 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
4069 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
4070 files contain lines that look like this:
4073 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
4074 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
4077 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
4078 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
4079 because 61 is less than 129.
4082 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
4083 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
4086 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
4087 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
4088 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
4089 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
4090 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
4091 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
4092 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
4093 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
4094 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
4095 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
4096 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
4097 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
4101 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
4104 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
4107 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
4108 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
4110 by the sort operation.
4112 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
4114 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
4115 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
4116 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
4119 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n'|perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g'|sort -z|perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
4123 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
4124 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
4125 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
4129 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
4135 @node shuf invocation
4136 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
4139 @cindex shuffling files
4141 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
4142 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
4146 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
4147 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
4148 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4151 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4152 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4153 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4161 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4162 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4164 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4165 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4167 @opindex --input-range
4168 @cindex input range to shuffle
4169 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4170 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4174 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4179 @item -n @var{lines}
4180 @itemx --head-count=@var{count}
4182 @opindex --head-count
4183 @cindex head of output
4184 Output at most @var{count} lines. By default, all input lines are
4187 @item -o @var{output-file}
4188 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4191 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4192 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4193 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4194 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4195 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4197 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4198 @opindex --random-source
4199 @cindex random source for shuffling
4200 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4201 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4204 @itemx --zero-terminated
4206 @opindex --zero-terminated
4207 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4208 Treat the input and output as a set of lines, each terminated by a zero byte
4209 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (Null) character) instead of an
4210 @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed).
4211 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
4212 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4213 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4214 or other special characters).
4230 might produce the output
4240 Similarly, the command:
4243 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4257 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4267 These examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4268 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4269 general, if there are @var{N} input lines, there are @var{N}! (i.e.,
4270 @var{N} factorial, or @var{N} * (@var{N} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4271 output permutations.
4276 @node uniq invocation
4277 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4280 @cindex uniquify files
4282 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4283 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4287 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4290 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4291 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4292 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4293 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4295 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4296 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4297 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4298 @xref{sort invocation}.
4301 Comparisons use the character collating sequence specified by the
4302 @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category.
4304 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4307 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4312 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4314 @opindex --skip-fields
4315 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4316 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4317 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4318 each other by at least one space or tab.
4320 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4321 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4324 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4326 @opindex --skip-chars
4327 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4328 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4329 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4331 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4332 On older systems, @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4334 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4335 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4336 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4337 behavior depends on this variable.
4338 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4339 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4345 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4348 @itemx --ignore-case
4350 @opindex --ignore-case
4351 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4357 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4358 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4359 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4363 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
4365 @opindex --all-repeated
4366 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
4367 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
4368 but discard lines that are not repeated.
4369 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
4370 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
4371 The optional @var{delimit-method} tells how to delimit
4372 groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the following:
4377 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
4378 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
4381 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
4382 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4383 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4386 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
4387 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4388 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4389 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
4390 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
4391 may be better suited for output direct to users.
4394 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
4395 two or more consecutive blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
4396 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\n'} to replace
4397 each sequence of consecutive newlines with a single newline.
4399 This is a @sc{gnu} extension.
4400 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
4406 @cindex unique lines, outputting
4407 Discard the first repeated line. When used by itself, this option
4408 causes @command{uniq} to print unique lines, and nothing else.
4411 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
4413 @opindex --check-chars
4414 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
4415 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
4419 @itemx --zero-terminated
4421 @opindex --zero-terminated
4422 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4423 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
4424 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
4425 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
4426 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{sort -z}, @samp{perl -0} or
4427 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4428 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4429 or other special characters).
4436 @node comm invocation
4437 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
4440 @cindex line-by-line comparison
4441 @cindex comparing sorted files
4443 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
4444 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
4445 standard input. Synopsis:
4448 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
4452 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
4453 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
4454 If an input file ends in a non-newline
4455 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
4456 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
4458 @cindex differing lines
4459 @cindex common lines
4460 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
4461 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
4462 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
4463 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
4464 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
4465 @c string, append `by default' to the above sentence.
4470 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
4471 the corresponding columns. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4473 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
4474 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
4475 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
4476 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
4478 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
4479 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
4480 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
4481 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If
4482 neither of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
4483 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable lines. If an
4484 input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\} command
4485 will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
4487 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
4488 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
4489 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
4490 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
4492 @checkOrderOption{comm}
4497 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
4499 @item --nocheck-order
4500 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
4504 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
4505 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
4506 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
4508 The delimiter @var{str} may not be empty.
4512 @node tsort invocation
4513 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
4516 @cindex topological sort
4518 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
4519 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
4520 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
4524 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
4527 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
4528 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
4529 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
4543 will produce the output
4554 Consider a more realistic example.
4555 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
4556 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
4557 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
4558 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
4559 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
4560 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
4561 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
4562 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
4563 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
4564 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
4565 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
4566 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
4572 tail_file pretty_name
4573 tail_file write_header
4575 tail_forever recheck
4576 tail_forever pretty_name
4577 tail_forever write_header
4578 tail_forever dump_remainder
4581 tail_lines start_lines
4582 tail_lines dump_remainder
4583 tail_lines file_lines
4584 tail_lines pipe_lines
4586 tail_bytes start_bytes
4587 tail_bytes dump_remainder
4588 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
4589 file_lines dump_remainder
4593 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
4594 functions that satisfies your requirement.
4597 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
4617 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
4618 encountered to standard error.
4620 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
4621 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
4622 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
4623 precedes @code{main}.
4625 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
4628 @node tsort background
4629 @section @command{tsort}: Background
4631 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
4632 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
4633 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
4634 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
4637 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
4638 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
4639 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
4640 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
4641 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
4642 reference to @code{read}.
4644 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
4645 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
4646 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
4647 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
4650 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
4651 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
4653 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
4654 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
4655 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
4656 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
4659 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
4660 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
4666 @node ptx invocation
4667 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
4671 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
4672 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
4675 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
4676 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4679 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
4680 all @sc{gnu} extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
4681 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
4682 When @option{-G} is not specified, @sc{gnu} extensions are always enabled.
4683 @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
4684 document. For the full list, see @xref{Compatibility in ptx}.
4686 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
4688 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
4689 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
4690 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
4691 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
4692 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
4693 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
4694 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
4695 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
4698 When @sc{gnu} extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
4699 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
4700 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
4701 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
4702 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
4703 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
4704 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
4705 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
4706 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
4707 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
4708 compatibility; @sc{gnu} Standards normally discourage output parameters not
4709 introduced by an option.
4711 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
4712 input text file, a single dash @kbd{-} may be used, in which case
4713 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
4714 convention more than once per program invocation.
4717 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
4718 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
4719 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
4720 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
4721 * Compatibility in ptx::
4725 @node General options in ptx
4726 @subsection General options
4731 @itemx --traditional
4732 As already explained, this option disables all @sc{gnu} extensions to
4733 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
4736 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
4740 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
4748 @node Charset selection in ptx
4749 @subsection Charset selection
4751 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
4752 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
4753 using 8-bit @acronym{ISO} 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
4754 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
4755 character set of the IBM-PC@. (@sc{gnu} @command{ptx} is not known to work on
4756 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit @acronym{ASCII}, the set
4757 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
4758 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
4759 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
4760 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
4766 @itemx --ignore-case
4767 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
4772 @node Input processing in ptx
4773 @subsection Word selection and input processing
4778 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
4780 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
4781 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
4782 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
4783 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
4784 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
4785 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
4786 @option{-b} is ignored.
4788 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
4789 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
4790 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When @sc{gnu} extensions
4791 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
4792 characters even if not included in the Break file.
4795 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
4797 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4798 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
4799 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
4800 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
4804 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
4806 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4807 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
4808 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
4809 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
4810 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
4812 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
4813 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
4814 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
4819 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
4820 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
4821 line in the resulting permuted index. For more information about reference
4822 production, see @xref{Output formatting in ptx}.
4823 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
4825 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
4826 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
4827 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
4828 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when @sc{gnu} extensions
4829 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
4830 excluded from the output contexts.
4832 @item -S @var{regexp}
4833 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
4835 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
4836 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
4837 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
4838 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
4839 default, when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
4840 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
4841 imported from @sc{gnu} Emacs:
4844 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
4847 Whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
4848 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
4854 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
4855 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
4856 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
4857 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
4858 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4861 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
4862 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
4863 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
4864 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
4865 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
4866 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
4867 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
4868 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
4869 on the right of the output line.
4871 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4872 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
4873 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4875 @item -W @var{regexp}
4876 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
4878 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
4879 By default, if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
4880 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When @sc{gnu} extensions are
4881 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
4882 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
4884 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
4885 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4888 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4889 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4890 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4895 @node Output formatting in ptx
4896 @subsection Output formatting
4898 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
4899 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
4900 selected, and if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
4901 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
4902 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
4903 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
4904 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
4905 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
4906 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
4907 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with @sc{gnu}
4908 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
4909 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
4910 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
4911 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
4912 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
4913 characters is transmitted verbatim.
4915 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
4919 @item -g @var{number}
4920 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
4922 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
4925 @item -w @var{number}
4926 @itemx --width=@var{number}
4928 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
4929 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
4930 depending on the value of option @option{-R}. If this option is not
4931 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
4932 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
4933 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
4934 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
4935 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
4939 @itemx --auto-reference
4941 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
4942 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
4943 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
4944 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
4945 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
4946 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
4949 @itemx --right-side-refs
4951 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
4952 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
4953 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
4954 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
4955 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
4956 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
4957 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
4958 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
4960 This option is automatically selected whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are
4963 @item -F @var{string}
4964 @itemx --flac-truncation=@var{string}
4966 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
4967 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
4968 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
4969 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}. But there is a maximum
4970 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
4971 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
4972 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
4973 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
4974 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
4976 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F ...}.
4977 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
4978 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
4981 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4982 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4983 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4985 @item -M @var{string}
4986 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
4988 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
4989 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
4992 @itemx --format=roff
4994 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
4995 processing. Each output line will look like:
4998 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}" "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5001 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5002 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when @sc{gnu}
5003 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5004 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5006 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5007 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
5008 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character: @kbd{"} is doubled
5009 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
5014 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
5015 line will look like:
5018 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
5022 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
5023 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
5024 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
5025 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
5026 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
5029 In this output format, some special characters, like @kbd{$}, @kbd{%},
5030 @kbd{&}, @kbd{#} and @kbd{_} are automatically protected with a
5031 backslash. Curly brackets @kbd{@{}, @kbd{@}} are protected with a
5032 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
5033 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
5034 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
5035 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
5036 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
5037 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
5038 and all other characters which are not part of @acronym{ASCII}, are merely
5039 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
5040 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
5041 processing for @TeX{}.
5046 @node Compatibility in ptx
5047 @subsection The @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx}
5049 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
5050 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
5051 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
5052 options. Some @sc{gnu} extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
5053 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about @sc{gnu} extensions.
5054 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
5059 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
5060 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
5061 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
5062 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
5065 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
5066 practice which @sc{gnu} avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
5067 portably between @sc{gnu} and System V, you should always use it with a
5068 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
5069 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
5070 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
5071 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
5074 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
5075 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
5076 @option{-w}. All other options are @sc{gnu} extensions and are not repeated in
5077 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
5078 meaning when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, as explained below.
5081 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
5082 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
5083 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
5086 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
5087 subtracted from the total output line width. With @sc{gnu} extensions
5088 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
5089 line width computations.
5092 All 256 bytes, even null bytes, are always read and processed from
5093 input file with no adverse effect, even if @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled.
5094 However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit characters, a few
5095 control characters are rejected, and the tilde @kbd{~} is also rejected.
5098 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if @sc{gnu}
5099 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
5100 the first 200 characters in each line.
5103 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
5104 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When @sc{gnu}
5105 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
5109 The program makes better use of output line width. If @sc{gnu} extensions
5110 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
5111 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
5112 not completely reproduce.
5115 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
5116 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
5121 @node Operating on fields within a line
5122 @chapter Operating on fields within a line
5125 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
5126 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
5127 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
5131 @node cut invocation
5132 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
5135 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
5136 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
5140 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5143 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
5144 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
5145 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
5146 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
5147 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
5148 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
5149 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
5150 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
5151 is written exactly once.
5153 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
5158 @item -b @var{byte-list}
5159 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
5162 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
5163 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
5164 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
5165 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
5166 string between ranges of selected bytes.
5168 @item -c @var{character-list}
5169 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
5171 @opindex --characters
5172 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
5173 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
5174 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
5175 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
5176 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
5177 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
5180 @item -f @var{field-list}
5181 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5184 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5185 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5186 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5187 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified
5189 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5190 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5192 @opindex --delimiter
5193 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5194 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5198 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5201 @itemx --only-delimited
5203 @opindex --only-delimited
5204 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5205 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5207 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5208 @opindex --output-delimiter
5209 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5210 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5211 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5212 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5213 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5214 ranges of selected bytes.
5217 @opindex --complement
5218 This option is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
5219 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5220 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5221 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5222 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5223 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5230 @node paste invocation
5231 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5234 @cindex merging files
5236 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
5237 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
5238 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
5260 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5263 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5271 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
5272 file. Using the above example data:
5275 $ paste -s num2 let3
5280 @item -d @var{delim-list}
5281 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
5283 @opindex --delimiters
5284 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
5285 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
5286 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
5289 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
5300 @node join invocation
5301 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
5304 @cindex common field, joining on
5306 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
5307 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
5310 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5313 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
5314 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
5315 sorted on the join fields.
5318 Normally, the sort order is that of the
5319 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
5320 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
5321 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
5322 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
5323 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
5325 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
5326 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
5327 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
5328 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
5329 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
5330 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
5332 If the input has no unpairable lines, a @acronym{GNU} extension is
5333 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
5334 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
5335 considers them to be equal. For example:
5352 @checkOrderOption{join}
5356 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
5357 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
5358 blanks on the line ignored;
5359 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
5360 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
5361 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
5364 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5368 @item -a @var{file-number}
5370 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
5371 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
5374 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5376 @item --nocheck-order
5377 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
5379 @item -e @var{string}
5381 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with
5385 @itemx --ignore-case
5387 @opindex --ignore-case
5388 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
5389 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
5390 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
5392 @item -1 @var{field}
5394 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
5396 @item -2 @var{field}
5398 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
5400 @item -j @var{field}
5401 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
5403 @item -o @var{field-list}
5404 Construct each output line according to the format in @var{field-list}.
5405 Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single character @samp{0} or
5406 has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m}, is @samp{1} or
5407 @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
5409 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
5410 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
5411 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
5412 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
5413 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
5414 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
5415 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
5416 To give @command{join} that functionality, @acronym{POSIX} invented the @samp{0}
5417 field specification notation.
5419 The elements in @var{field-list}
5420 are separated by commas or blanks.
5421 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
5422 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
5423 2.2'} are equivalent.
5425 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
5426 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
5429 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
5430 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
5431 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
5432 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering.
5434 @item -v @var{file-number}
5435 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
5436 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
5443 @node Operating on characters
5444 @chapter Operating on characters
5446 @cindex operating on characters
5448 This commands operate on individual characters.
5451 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
5452 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
5453 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
5458 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
5465 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
5468 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
5469 one of the following operations:
5473 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
5475 squeeze repeated characters,
5479 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
5482 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
5483 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
5484 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
5485 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
5487 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
5489 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
5490 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
5491 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
5492 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
5493 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
5494 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
5495 the input contains encoding errors.
5497 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
5498 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
5503 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
5504 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
5505 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
5509 @node Character sets
5510 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
5512 @cindex specifying sets of characters
5514 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
5515 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
5516 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
5517 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
5518 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
5519 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
5523 @item Backslash escapes
5524 @cindex backslash escapes
5526 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
5544 The character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
5550 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
5551 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
5552 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
5553 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
5558 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
5559 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
5560 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
5561 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
5563 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
5564 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
5565 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
5566 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
5567 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
5570 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
5571 portable. For example, on @acronym{EBCDIC} hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
5572 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
5573 are not contiguous as they are in @acronym{ASCII}.
5574 If you can rely on a @acronym{POSIX} compliant version of @command{tr}, then
5575 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
5576 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
5579 @item Repeated characters
5580 @cindex repeated characters
5582 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
5583 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
5584 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
5585 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
5586 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
5587 octal, otherwise in decimal.
5589 @item Character classes
5590 @cindex character classes
5592 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
5593 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
5594 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
5595 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
5596 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
5597 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
5598 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
5599 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
5600 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
5601 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
5602 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
5614 Horizontal whitespace.
5623 Printable characters, not including space.
5629 Printable characters, including space.
5632 Punctuation characters.
5635 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
5644 @item Equivalence classes
5645 @cindex equivalence classes
5647 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
5648 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
5649 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
5650 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
5651 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in @sc{gnu} @command{tr};
5652 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
5653 which is of no particular use.
5659 @subsection Translating
5661 @cindex translating characters
5663 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
5664 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
5665 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
5666 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
5667 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
5668 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
5669 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
5670 two commands are equivalent:
5677 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
5678 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
5681 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
5683 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
5687 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
5689 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
5690 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
5691 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
5693 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
5694 portable; @acronym{POSIX} says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
5695 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
5696 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
5697 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
5699 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
5700 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
5701 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
5702 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
5704 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
5708 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
5712 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
5713 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
5717 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
5718 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
5719 Assuming a @acronym{POSIX} compliant @command{tr}, here is a better way to write it:
5722 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5727 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
5729 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
5730 @cindex deleting characters
5732 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
5733 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
5735 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option,
5736 @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a repeated character that
5737 is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of that character.
5739 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
5740 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
5741 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5743 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
5744 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
5745 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5747 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
5752 Remove all zero bytes:
5759 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
5760 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
5761 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
5764 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5768 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline:
5775 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
5776 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
5777 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
5778 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
5779 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
5780 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
5781 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
5782 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
5788 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
5789 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
5794 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
5795 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
5801 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
5802 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
5803 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
5804 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
5805 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
5806 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
5807 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
5808 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
5809 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
5816 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
5822 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
5823 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
5829 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
5830 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
5835 @node expand invocation
5836 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
5839 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
5840 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
5842 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
5843 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
5844 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
5848 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5851 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
5852 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
5853 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
5854 tabs every 8 columns).
5856 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5860 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5861 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5864 @cindex tab stops, setting
5865 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
5866 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
5867 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
5868 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
5869 blanks as well as by commas.
5871 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
5872 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
5873 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
5879 @cindex initial tabs, converting
5880 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
5881 characters) on each line to spaces.
5888 @node unexpand invocation
5889 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
5893 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
5894 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
5895 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
5896 as many tab characters as needed. In the default @acronym{POSIX}
5897 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
5898 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
5901 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5904 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
5905 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
5906 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
5907 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
5910 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5914 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5915 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5918 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
5919 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
5920 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
5921 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
5922 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
5924 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
5925 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
5926 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
5927 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
5928 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
5934 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
5935 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
5942 @node Directory listing
5943 @chapter Directory listing
5945 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
5946 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
5949 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
5950 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
5951 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
5952 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
5957 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
5960 @cindex directory listing
5962 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
5963 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
5964 arbitrarily, as usual.
5966 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
5967 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
5968 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
5969 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
5970 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
5971 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
5974 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
5975 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-@acronym{POSIX}
5976 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
5977 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
5978 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
5979 If standard output is
5980 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
5981 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
5982 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
5984 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
5985 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
5986 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
5987 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
5988 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
5990 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
5995 1 minor problems (e.g., a subdirectory was not found)
5996 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted)
5999 Also see @ref{Common options}.
6002 * Which files are listed::
6003 * What information is listed::
6004 * Sorting the output::
6005 * More details about version sort::
6006 * General output formatting::
6007 * Formatting file timestamps::
6008 * Formatting the file names::
6012 @node Which files are listed
6013 @subsection Which files are listed
6015 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
6016 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
6017 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
6018 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
6026 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
6031 @opindex --almost-all
6032 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
6033 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
6034 option overrides this option.
6037 @itemx --ignore-backups
6039 @opindex --ignore-backups
6040 @cindex backup files, ignoring
6041 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
6042 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
6047 @opindex --directory
6048 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
6049 than listing their contents.
6050 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
6051 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6052 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6053 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6054 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6057 @itemx --dereference-command-line
6059 @opindex --dereference-command-line
6060 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6061 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
6062 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
6064 @itemx --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6065 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6066 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6067 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
6068 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
6069 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
6071 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
6072 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
6073 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
6075 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6076 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
6078 @item --group-directories-first
6079 @opindex --group-directories-first
6080 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
6081 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
6082 (see --sort option).
6083 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
6084 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
6085 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
6086 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
6088 @item --hide=PATTERN
6089 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
6090 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6091 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
6092 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
6093 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
6094 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
6095 (@option{-A}) is also given.
6097 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
6098 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
6099 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
6100 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
6102 @item -I @var{pattern}
6103 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
6105 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
6106 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6107 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
6108 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
6109 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
6110 to give this option several times. For example,
6113 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
6116 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
6117 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
6118 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
6121 @itemx --dereference
6123 @opindex --dereference
6124 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6125 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
6126 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
6127 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
6128 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
6133 @opindex --recursive
6134 @cindex recursive directory listing
6135 @cindex directory listing, recursive
6136 List the contents of all directories recursively.
6141 @node What information is listed
6142 @subsection What information is listed
6144 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
6145 default, only file names are shown.
6151 @cindex hurd, author, printing
6152 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
6153 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
6154 operating systems the two are the same.
6160 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
6161 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
6165 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
6169 The @var{begN} and @var{endN} are unsigned integers that record the
6170 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
6171 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
6172 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
6174 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
6175 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
6178 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
6181 Finally, output a line of the form:
6184 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
6188 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
6190 Here is an actual example:
6193 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
6195 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
6196 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
6199 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
6200 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
6201 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
6202 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
6206 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
6210 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
6214 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
6215 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
6216 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
6219 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
6220 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
6222 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
6223 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
6225 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
6226 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
6229 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
6230 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
6234 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
6235 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
6236 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
6237 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
6238 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
6243 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
6244 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
6246 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
6249 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
6250 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
6251 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
6252 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
6253 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
6254 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
6255 prepared to parse the escaped names.
6258 @opindex --full-time
6259 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
6260 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
6261 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
6265 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
6271 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
6272 (This is the default in some non-@sc{gnu} versions of @command{ls}, so we
6273 provide this option for compatibility.)
6281 @cindex inode number, printing
6282 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
6283 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
6284 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
6287 @itemx --format=long
6288 @itemx --format=verbose
6291 @opindex long ls @r{format}
6292 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
6293 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
6294 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
6295 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
6296 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
6297 cannot be determined.
6299 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
6300 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
6301 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
6302 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
6303 separator of the current locale.
6305 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
6306 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
6307 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
6308 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6309 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
6310 this is arguably a deficiency.
6312 The file type is one of the following characters:
6314 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
6322 character special file
6324 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
6328 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
6330 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
6334 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
6336 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
6338 network special file (HP-UX)
6342 port (Solaris 10 and up)
6344 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
6348 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6350 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6352 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
6354 some other file type
6357 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
6358 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
6359 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
6360 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
6364 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
6368 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
6369 executable bit is not set.
6372 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
6373 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
6374 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
6377 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
6378 other-executable bit is not set.
6381 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
6387 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
6388 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
6389 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
6390 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
6391 character, then there is such a method.
6393 For a file with an extended access control list, a @samp{+} character is
6394 listed. Basic access control lists are equivalent to the permissions
6395 listed, and are not considered an alternate access method.
6398 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
6400 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
6401 @cindex numeric uid and gid
6402 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
6403 Produce long format directory listings, but
6404 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
6408 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
6409 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
6415 @cindex disk allocation
6416 @cindex size of files, reporting
6417 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
6418 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
6419 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
6421 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
6422 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6424 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
6425 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
6426 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
6427 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
6428 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
6429 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
6436 @node Sorting the output
6437 @subsection Sorting the output
6439 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
6440 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
6441 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
6442 (e.g., @acronym{ASCII} order).
6448 @itemx --time=status
6451 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
6452 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
6453 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6454 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
6455 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
6456 the modification time.
6457 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6458 or when not using a long listing format,
6459 sort according to the status change time.
6463 @cindex unsorted directory listing
6464 @cindex directory order, listing by
6465 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
6466 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
6467 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
6468 were specified before the @option{-f}).
6474 @cindex reverse sorting
6475 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
6476 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
6482 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
6483 Sort by file size, largest first.
6489 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
6490 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
6494 @itemx --time=access
6498 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6499 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6500 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6501 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
6502 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
6503 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6504 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
6510 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6511 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
6512 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
6513 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
6514 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
6517 @itemx --sort=version
6520 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6521 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
6522 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
6523 as an index/version number. (@xref{More details about version sort}.)
6526 @itemx --sort=extension
6529 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
6530 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
6531 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
6536 @node More details about version sort
6537 @subsection More details about version sort
6539 The version sort takes into account the fact that file names frequently include
6540 indices or version numbers. Standard sorting functions usually do not produce
6541 the ordering that people expect because comparisons are made on a
6542 character-by-character basis. The version
6543 sort addresses this problem, and is especially useful when browsing
6544 directories that contain many files with indices/version numbers in their
6549 foo.zml-1.gz foo.zml-1.gz
6550 foo.zml-100.gz foo.zml-2.gz
6551 foo.zml-12.gz foo.zml-6.gz
6552 foo.zml-13.gz foo.zml-12.gz
6553 foo.zml-2.gz foo.zml-13.gz
6554 foo.zml-25.gz foo.zml-25.gz
6555 foo.zml-6.gz foo.zml-100.gz
6558 Note also that numeric parts with leading zeros are considered as
6563 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
6564 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
6565 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
6568 This functionality is implemented using the @code{strverscmp} function.
6569 @xref{String/Array Comparison, , , libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
6570 One result of that implementation decision is that @code{ls -v} does not
6571 use the locale category, @env{LC_COLLATE}. As a result, non-numeric prefixes
6572 are sorted as if @env{LC_COLLATE} were set to @code{C}.
6574 @node General output formatting
6575 @subsection General output formatting
6577 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
6582 @itemx --format=single-column
6585 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
6586 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
6587 output is not a terminal.
6590 @itemx --format=vertical
6593 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
6594 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
6595 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
6596 for the @command{dir} program.
6597 @sc{gnu} @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
6598 possible in the fewest lines.
6600 @item --color [=@var{when}]
6602 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
6603 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
6604 may be omitted, or one of:
6607 @vindex none @r{color option}
6608 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
6610 @vindex auto @r{color option}
6611 @cindex terminal, using color iff
6612 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
6614 @vindex always @r{color option}
6617 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
6618 @option{--color=always}.
6619 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
6620 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
6621 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
6625 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
6628 @opindex --indicator-style
6629 @cindex file type and executables, marking
6630 @cindex executables and file type, marking
6631 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
6632 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
6633 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
6634 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
6635 and nothing for regular files.
6636 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
6637 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6638 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6639 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6640 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6643 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
6644 @opindex --file-type
6645 @opindex --indicator-style
6646 @cindex file type, marking
6647 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
6648 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
6650 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
6651 @opindex --indicator-style
6652 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
6657 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
6659 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
6662 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
6663 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
6664 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
6666 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
6667 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
6668 @option{--classify} option.
6673 Print file sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block
6674 size (@pxref{Block size}).
6675 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
6678 @itemx --format=commas
6681 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
6682 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
6683 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
6686 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
6688 @opindex --indicator-style
6689 @cindex file type, marking
6690 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
6693 @itemx --format=across
6694 @itemx --format=horizontal
6697 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
6698 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
6699 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
6702 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
6705 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
6706 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
6707 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
6709 @c FIXME: remove in 2009, if Apple Terminal has been fixed for long enough.
6710 Some terminal emulators (at least Apple Terminal 1.5 (133) from Mac OS X 10.4.8)
6711 do not properly align columns to the right of a TAB following a
6712 non-@acronym{ASCII} byte. If you use such a terminal emulator, use the
6713 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment to tell
6714 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
6717 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
6721 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
6722 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
6723 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
6729 @node Formatting file timestamps
6730 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
6732 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form. Most
6733 locales use a timestamp like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. However, the
6734 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002}
6735 for non-recent timestamps, and a date-without-year and time like
6736 @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
6738 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
6739 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
6740 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
6741 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
6742 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
6745 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
6746 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
6747 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
6748 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
6750 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
6753 @item --time-style=@var{style}
6754 @opindex --time-style
6756 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
6757 be one of the following:
6762 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
6763 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
6764 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
6765 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
6766 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
6767 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
6769 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
6770 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
6771 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
6772 spaces in one of the two formats.
6775 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
6776 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
6777 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
6778 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
6780 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
6781 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
6782 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since @acronym{GNU} @command{make}
6783 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
6786 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
6787 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
6788 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
6789 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
6792 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
6793 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and @acronym{ISO} 8601 month, day, hour, and
6794 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
6795 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
6796 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
6797 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
6798 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6803 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
6804 ls -l --time-style="iso"
6809 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
6810 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
6811 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
6812 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
6813 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
6814 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
6816 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
6817 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
6818 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
6819 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6824 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
6825 ls -l --time-style="locale"
6828 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
6829 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
6830 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
6831 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
6832 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
6834 @item posix-@var{style}
6836 List @acronym{POSIX}-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
6837 category is @acronym{POSIX}, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
6838 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
6839 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
6840 the @acronym{POSIX} locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
6845 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
6846 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
6847 the default style is @samp{locale}. @acronym{GNU} Emacs 21.3 and
6848 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
6849 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
6850 non-@acronym{POSIX} locale you may need to set
6851 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
6853 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
6854 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
6857 @node Formatting the file names
6858 @subsection Formatting the file names
6860 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
6866 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
6869 @opindex --quoting-style
6870 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
6871 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
6872 backslash sequences like those used in C.
6876 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
6879 @opindex --quoting-style
6880 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
6881 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
6882 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
6886 @itemx --hide-control-chars
6888 @opindex --hide-control-chars
6889 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
6890 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
6895 @itemx --quoting-style=c
6897 @opindex --quote-name
6898 @opindex --quoting-style
6899 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
6902 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
6903 @opindex --quoting-style
6904 @cindex quoting style
6905 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
6906 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
6907 be one of the following:
6911 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
6912 @option{--literal} option.
6914 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
6915 cause ambiguous output.
6916 The quoting is suitable for @acronym{POSIX}-compatible shells like
6917 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
6920 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
6922 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
6923 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
6924 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
6926 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
6927 surrounding double-quote
6928 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
6930 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6931 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
6934 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
6935 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6936 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
6937 @t{`like this'} instead of @t{"like
6938 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
6941 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
6942 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. If that environment
6943 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{literal}, but this
6944 default may change to @samp{shell} in a future version of this package.
6946 @item --show-control-chars
6947 @opindex --show-control-chars
6948 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
6949 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
6955 @node dir invocation
6956 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
6959 @cindex directory listing, brief
6961 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
6962 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
6963 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6965 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
6968 @node vdir invocation
6969 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
6972 @cindex directory listing, verbose
6974 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
6975 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
6976 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6978 @node dircolors invocation
6979 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
6983 @cindex setup for color
6985 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
6986 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
6990 eval "`dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]`"
6993 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
6994 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
6995 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
6996 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
6998 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
6999 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
7000 adapt them to your favorite shell):
7004 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
7008 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7009 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
7010 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
7011 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
7012 environment variable.
7014 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7019 @itemx --bourne-shell
7022 @opindex --bourne-shell
7023 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
7024 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
7025 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
7026 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
7035 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
7036 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
7037 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
7038 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
7041 @itemx --print-database
7043 @opindex --print-database
7044 @cindex color database, printing
7045 @cindex database for color setup, printing
7046 @cindex printing color database
7047 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
7048 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
7049 of the possibilities.
7056 @node Basic operations
7057 @chapter Basic operations
7059 @cindex manipulating files
7061 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
7062 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
7065 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
7066 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
7067 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
7068 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
7069 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
7070 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
7075 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
7078 @cindex copying files and directories
7079 @cindex files, copying
7080 @cindex directories, copying
7082 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
7083 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
7084 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
7088 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7089 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7090 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7095 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
7099 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7100 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7101 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7102 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
7103 using the @var{source}s' names.
7106 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
7107 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
7109 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
7110 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
7111 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
7112 to corresponding destination directories.
7114 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
7115 link only when not copying
7116 recursively. This default can be overridden with the
7117 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
7118 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
7119 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
7120 the last one silently overrides the others.
7122 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
7123 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
7124 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
7125 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
7126 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
7127 practice and to @acronym{POSIX}.
7128 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
7129 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
7130 Also, when an option like
7131 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
7132 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
7133 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
7135 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
7136 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
7137 @option{--copy-contents} option.
7139 @cindex self-backups
7140 @cindex backups, making only
7141 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
7142 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
7143 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
7144 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
7145 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
7146 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
7148 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7155 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
7156 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
7157 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
7158 directory in a different order).
7159 Equivalent to @option{-dpR}.
7162 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
7165 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
7166 @cindex backups, making
7167 @xref{Backup options}.
7168 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
7169 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
7170 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
7171 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
7172 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
7176 # Usage: backup FILE...
7177 # Create a @sc{gnu}-style backup of each listed FILE.
7179 cp --backup --force -- "$i" "$i"
7183 @item --copy-contents
7184 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7185 @cindex copying directories recursively
7186 @cindex recursively copying directories
7187 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7188 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
7189 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
7190 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
7191 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
7192 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
7193 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
7194 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
7195 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
7196 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
7197 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
7198 affect the copying of symbolic links.
7202 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7203 @cindex hard links, preserving
7204 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7205 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
7206 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
7212 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
7213 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force}),
7214 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
7215 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
7216 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
7217 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
7218 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
7220 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
7221 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
7225 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
7226 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
7227 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
7228 via recursive traversal.
7231 @itemx --interactive
7233 @opindex --interactive
7234 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
7235 overwrite an existing destination file.
7241 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
7244 @itemx --dereference
7246 @opindex --dereference
7247 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
7250 @itemx --no-dereference
7252 @opindex --no-dereference
7253 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7254 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7255 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
7256 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
7259 @itemx @w{@kbd{--preserve}[=@var{attribute_list}]}
7262 @cindex file information, preserving
7263 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
7264 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
7265 of one or more of the following strings:
7269 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
7271 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
7272 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
7274 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
7275 a member of the desired group.
7277 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
7278 In general, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
7279 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
7280 However, FreeBSD now provides the @code{lutimes} function, which makes
7281 it possible even for symbolic links. However, this implementation does
7282 not yet take advantage of that.
7283 @c FIXME: once we provide lutimes support, update the above.
7285 Preserve in the destination files
7286 any links between corresponding source files.
7287 @c Give examples illustrating how hard links are preserved.
7288 @c Also, show how soft links map to hard links with -L and -H.
7290 Preserve all file attributes.
7291 Equivalent to specifying all of the above.
7294 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
7295 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
7297 In the absence of this option, each destination file is created with the
7298 mode bits of the corresponding source file, minus the bits set in the
7299 umask and minus the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits.
7300 @xref{File permissions}.
7302 @itemx @w{@kbd{--no-preserve}=@var{attribute_list}}
7303 @cindex file information, preserving
7304 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
7305 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
7309 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
7310 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
7311 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
7312 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
7313 For example, the command:
7316 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
7320 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
7321 any missing intermediate directories.
7323 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
7325 @cindex interactivity
7326 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
7327 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
7328 Using @option{--reply=yes} makes @command{cp} act as if @samp{yes} were
7329 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file. That effectively
7330 cancels any preceding @option{--interactive} or @option{-i} option.
7331 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{cp} act as if @samp{no} were
7332 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
7333 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{cp} prompt the user
7334 about each existing destination file.
7341 @opindex --recursive
7342 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7343 @cindex copying directories recursively
7344 @cindex recursively copying directories
7345 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7346 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
7347 links in the source; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
7348 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
7349 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
7350 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
7351 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
7352 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
7353 non-@sc{gnu} systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
7354 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
7355 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
7356 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as @acronym{POSIX} allows
7357 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
7359 @item --remove-destination
7360 @opindex --remove-destination
7361 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
7362 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
7364 @item --sparse=@var{when}
7365 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
7366 @cindex sparse files, copying
7367 @cindex holes, copying files with
7368 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
7369 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
7370 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
7371 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
7372 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
7373 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
7374 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
7375 Only regular files may be sparse.
7377 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
7381 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
7382 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
7383 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
7386 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
7387 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
7388 input file does not appear to be sparse.
7389 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
7390 that does not support sparse files
7391 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
7392 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
7393 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
7394 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
7397 Never make the output file sparse.
7398 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
7399 since such a file must not have any holes.
7402 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7405 @itemx --symbolic-link
7407 @opindex --symbolic-link
7408 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
7409 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
7410 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
7411 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
7412 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
7418 @optNoTargetDirectory
7424 @cindex newer files, copying only
7425 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7426 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
7427 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
7428 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
7429 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
7430 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and
7437 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7440 @itemx --one-file-system
7442 @opindex --one-file-system
7443 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
7444 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
7445 the copy started on.
7446 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
7454 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
7457 @cindex converting while copying a file
7459 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
7460 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
7461 conversions on it. Synopses:
7464 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
7468 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
7469 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands.
7475 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
7479 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
7480 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
7481 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
7483 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
7485 @cindex block size of input
7486 @cindex input block size
7487 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
7488 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
7490 @item obs=@var{bytes}
7492 @cindex block size of output
7493 @cindex output block size
7494 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
7495 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
7497 @item bs=@var{bytes}
7500 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
7501 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
7502 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
7504 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
7506 @cindex block size of conversion
7507 @cindex conversion block size
7508 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
7509 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
7510 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
7511 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
7512 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
7513 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
7515 @item skip=@var{blocks}
7517 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
7519 @item seek=@var{blocks}
7521 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
7523 @item count=@var{blocks}
7525 Copy @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
7526 of everything until the end of the file.
7528 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
7530 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
7531 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7538 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
7539 Convert @acronym{EBCDIC} to @acronym{ASCII},
7540 using the conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7541 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
7544 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7545 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to @acronym{EBCDIC}.
7546 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
7549 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7550 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to alternate @acronym{EBCDIC},
7551 using the alternate conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7552 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
7553 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
7555 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
7559 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
7560 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
7561 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
7565 Replace trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block with a
7568 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7571 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
7572 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
7575 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
7576 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
7578 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7581 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
7582 @cindex byte-swapping
7583 Swap every pair of input bytes. @sc{gnu} @command{dd}, unlike others, works
7584 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
7585 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
7589 @cindex read errors, ignoring
7590 Continue after read errors.
7594 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
7595 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
7599 @cindex creating output file, requiring
7600 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
7603 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7607 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
7608 Do not truncate the output file.
7611 @opindex sync @r{(padding with nulls)}
7612 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
7613 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
7618 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
7619 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
7620 write of output data.
7624 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
7625 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
7626 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
7630 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7632 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7633 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7635 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7637 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7638 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7640 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
7647 @cindex appending to the output file
7648 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
7649 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
7650 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
7651 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
7652 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
7653 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
7658 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
7662 @cindex directory I/O
7664 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
7665 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
7669 @cindex synchronized data reads
7670 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
7671 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
7672 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
7673 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
7674 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
7678 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
7679 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
7683 @cindex nonblocking I/O
7684 Use non-blocking I/O.
7689 Do not update the file's access time.
7690 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
7691 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
7695 @cindex controlling terminal
7696 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
7697 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
7698 On many hosts (e.g., @acronym{GNU}/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
7703 @cindex symbolic links, following
7704 Do not follow symbolic links.
7709 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
7714 Use binary I/O. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
7715 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
7720 Use text I/O. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
7725 Accumulate full blocks from input. The @code{read} system call
7726 may return early if a full block is not available.
7727 When that happens, continue calling @code{read} to fill the remainder
7729 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
7733 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
7734 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
7735 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
7736 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
7737 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
7738 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
7742 @cindex multipliers after numbers
7743 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{bytes} and @var{blocks}) can be
7744 followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
7745 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
7746 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
7748 Use different @command{dd} invocations to use different block sizes for
7749 skipping and I/O@. For example, the following shell commands copy data
7750 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save or restore a
7751 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
7754 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
7757 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
7758 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
7760 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
7761 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
7764 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal to a running @command{dd}
7765 process makes it print I/O statistics to standard error
7766 and then resume copying. In the example below,
7767 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 10 million blocks.
7768 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
7769 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
7770 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
7773 $ dd if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=10MB & pid=$!
7774 $ kill -s INFO $pid; wait $pid
7775 3385223+0 records in
7776 3385223+0 records out
7777 1733234176 bytes (1.7 GB) copied, 6.42173 seconds, 270 MB/s
7778 10000000+0 records in
7779 10000000+0 records out
7780 5120000000 bytes (5.1 GB) copied, 18.913 seconds, 271 MB/s
7783 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
7784 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
7785 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
7786 environment variable is set.
7791 @node install invocation
7792 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
7795 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
7797 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
7798 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
7801 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7802 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7803 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7804 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
7809 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
7813 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7814 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7815 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7816 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
7817 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7820 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
7821 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
7822 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
7823 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
7824 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
7825 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
7828 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
7829 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
7830 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
7831 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
7832 files onto themselves.
7834 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7842 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
7846 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
7847 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
7848 This option is ignored if a destination directory is specified
7849 via @option{--target-directory=DIR}.
7854 @opindex --directory
7855 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
7856 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
7857 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
7858 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
7859 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
7860 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
7862 @item -g @var{group}
7863 @itemx --group=@var{group}
7866 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
7867 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
7868 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
7869 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
7872 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
7875 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
7876 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
7877 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
7878 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
7879 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
7880 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
7881 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
7882 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
7883 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
7884 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
7885 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
7887 @item -o @var{owner}
7888 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
7891 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
7892 @cindex appropriate privileges
7893 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
7894 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
7895 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
7896 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
7900 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
7902 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
7903 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
7904 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
7905 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
7906 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
7907 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
7908 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
7909 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
7910 to when they were last installed.
7916 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
7917 @cindex stripping symbol table information
7918 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
7924 @optNoTargetDirectory
7930 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7938 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
7942 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
7945 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7946 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7947 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7952 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
7956 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7957 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7958 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7959 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
7960 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7963 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
7964 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
7965 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
7966 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
7967 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
7968 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
7969 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
7970 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
7971 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
7972 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
7973 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
7974 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
7977 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
7978 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
7979 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
7980 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
7981 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
7982 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7984 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
7985 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
7986 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
7987 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
7988 On a system with a modern Linux-based kernel, it fails with @code{errno=ENOTDIR}.
7989 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
7990 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
7991 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
7993 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8003 @cindex prompts, omitting
8004 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
8007 @itemx --interactive
8009 @opindex --interactive
8010 @cindex prompts, forcing
8011 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
8013 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8015 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
8017 @cindex interactivity
8018 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
8019 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
8020 Specifying @option{--reply=yes} is equivalent to using @option{--force}.
8021 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{mv} act as if @samp{no} were
8022 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
8023 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{mv} prompt the user
8024 about each existing destination file.
8025 Note that @option{--reply=no} has an effect only when @command{mv} would prompt
8026 without @option{-i} or equivalent, i.e., when a destination file exists and is
8027 not writable, standard input is a terminal, and no @option{-f} (or equivalent)
8028 option is specified.
8034 @cindex newer files, moving only
8035 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
8036 same or newer modification time.
8037 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
8038 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
8039 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
8040 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
8041 same source and destination.
8047 Print the name of each file before moving it.
8049 @optStripTrailingSlashes
8055 @optNoTargetDirectory
8063 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
8066 @cindex removing files or directories
8068 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
8069 directories. Synopsis:
8072 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
8075 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
8076 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
8077 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
8078 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
8079 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
8080 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
8082 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
8083 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
8084 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
8085 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
8086 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8088 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
8089 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting.
8091 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
8092 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
8093 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
8095 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8103 Ignore nonexistent files and never prompt the user.
8104 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
8108 Prompt whether to remove each file.
8109 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
8110 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
8111 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
8115 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
8116 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
8117 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
8118 @option{--interactive=once}.
8120 @itemx --interactive [=@var{when}]
8121 @opindex --interactive
8122 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
8126 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
8127 - Do not prompt at all.
8129 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
8130 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
8131 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
8133 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
8134 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
8136 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
8137 @option{--interactive=always}.
8139 @itemx --one-file-system
8140 @opindex --one-file-system
8141 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
8142 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
8143 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
8145 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
8146 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
8147 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
8148 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
8149 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
8150 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
8151 under @file{/home}, too.
8152 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
8153 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
8154 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
8155 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
8157 @itemx --preserve-root
8158 @opindex --preserve-root
8159 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
8160 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
8161 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
8162 This is the default behavior.
8163 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8165 @itemx --no-preserve-root
8166 @opindex --no-preserve-root
8167 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
8168 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
8169 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
8170 remove all the files on your computer.
8171 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8178 @opindex --recursive
8179 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
8180 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
8186 Print the name of each file before removing it.
8190 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
8191 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
8192 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
8193 @samp{-}. @sc{gnu} @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
8194 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
8195 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
8196 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
8209 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
8210 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
8211 predates the development of the getopt standard syntax.
8216 @node shred invocation
8217 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
8220 @cindex data, erasing
8221 @cindex erasing data
8223 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
8224 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
8226 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
8227 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
8228 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
8229 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
8230 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
8232 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
8233 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
8234 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
8235 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
8237 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
8238 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
8239 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
8240 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
8243 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
8244 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
8245 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
8246 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
8247 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
8249 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
8250 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
8251 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
8252 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
8253 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
8254 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
8255 from the proceedings of the Sixth @acronym{USENIX} Security Symposium (San Jose,
8256 California, July 22--25, 1996).
8258 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
8259 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
8260 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
8261 assumption. Exceptions include:
8266 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
8267 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
8268 BFS, NTFS, etc.@: when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
8271 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
8272 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
8275 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
8278 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
8282 Compressed file systems.
8285 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
8286 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
8287 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
8288 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
8289 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
8290 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
8291 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
8292 the mount man page (man mount).
8294 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
8295 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
8296 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
8298 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
8299 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
8300 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
8301 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
8302 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
8305 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
8306 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
8307 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
8308 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
8309 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
8312 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
8313 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
8314 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
8315 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
8316 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
8319 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
8322 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8330 @cindex force deletion
8331 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
8334 @itemx -n @var{NUMBER}
8335 @itemx --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8336 @opindex -n @var{NUMBER}
8337 @opindex --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8338 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
8339 By default, @command{shred} uses 25 passes of overwrite. This is enough
8340 for all of the useful overwrite patterns to be used at least once.
8341 You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you have a lot of
8344 @item --random-source=@var{file}
8345 @opindex --random-source
8346 @cindex random source for shredding
8347 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
8348 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
8350 @item -s @var{BYTES}
8351 @itemx --size=@var{BYTES}
8352 @opindex -s @var{BYTES}
8353 @opindex --size=@var{BYTES}
8354 @cindex size of file to shred
8355 Shred the first @var{BYTES} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
8356 the whole file. @var{BYTES} can be followed by a size specification like
8357 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
8363 @cindex removing files after shredding
8364 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
8365 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
8371 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
8377 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
8378 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the last block of the file.
8379 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
8380 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
8381 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
8382 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
8388 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
8389 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
8390 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
8391 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
8392 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
8393 by the @option{--iterations} option.
8397 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
8398 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
8399 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
8403 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
8406 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
8407 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
8410 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
8413 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
8414 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
8418 i=`tempfile -m 0600`
8421 echo "Hello, world" >&3
8426 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
8427 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
8428 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
8429 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
8434 @node Special file types
8435 @chapter Special file types
8437 @cindex special file types
8438 @cindex file types, special
8440 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
8441 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
8443 @cindex special file types
8445 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
8446 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
8447 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
8448 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
8449 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
8450 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
8451 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
8452 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
8454 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
8455 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
8458 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8459 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
8460 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
8461 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
8462 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
8463 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link.
8464 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
8465 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8469 @node link invocation
8470 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8473 @cindex links, creating
8474 @cindex hard links, creating
8475 @cindex creating links (hard only)
8477 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
8478 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
8479 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
8480 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8481 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
8482 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
8486 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
8489 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
8490 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
8491 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
8494 On a @acronym{GNU} system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
8495 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
8496 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
8497 not specified by @acronym{POSIX}, and the @command{link} command is
8498 more portable in practice.
8504 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
8507 @cindex links, creating
8508 @cindex hard links, creating
8509 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
8510 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
8512 @cindex file systems and hard links
8513 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
8514 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
8518 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
8519 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
8520 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
8521 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
8527 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
8528 file from the second.
8531 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
8532 in the current directory.
8535 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8536 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8537 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8538 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
8539 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
8543 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
8544 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
8545 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
8546 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
8549 @cindex hard link, defined
8550 @cindex inode, and hard links
8551 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
8552 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
8553 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
8554 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
8555 file. On all existing implementations, you cannot make a hard link to
8556 a directory, and hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
8557 restrictions are not mandated by @acronym{POSIX}, however.)
8559 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
8560 @cindex symbolic link, defined
8561 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
8562 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
8563 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
8564 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
8565 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
8566 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
8567 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
8568 link file itself, rather than on its target. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
8569 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8571 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8582 @opindex --directory
8583 @cindex hard links to directories
8584 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
8586 However, note that this will probably fail due to
8587 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
8593 Remove existing destination files.
8596 @itemx --interactive
8598 @opindex --interactive
8599 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
8600 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
8603 @itemx --no-dereference
8605 @opindex --no-dereference
8606 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
8607 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
8609 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
8610 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
8611 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
8612 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
8613 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
8614 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
8615 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
8616 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
8617 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
8618 just like a directory.
8620 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
8621 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
8627 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
8628 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
8634 @optNoTargetDirectory
8640 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
8651 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
8652 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
8657 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
8663 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
8664 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
8668 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
8669 # work across networked file systems.
8670 ln -s afile anotherfile
8671 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
8675 @node mkdir invocation
8676 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
8679 @cindex directories, creating
8680 @cindex creating directories
8682 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
8685 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
8688 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
8689 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
8690 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
8692 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8697 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8700 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
8701 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
8702 which uses the same syntax as
8703 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
8704 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
8706 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
8707 is created. As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @var{mode} may also mention
8708 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
8709 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
8710 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
8711 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
8712 overridden in this way.
8718 @cindex parent directories, creating
8719 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
8720 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
8721 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
8724 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
8725 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
8726 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
8727 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
8728 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
8729 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
8730 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
8731 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
8732 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
8738 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
8745 @node mkfifo invocation
8746 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
8749 @cindex FIFOs, creating
8750 @cindex named pipes, creating
8751 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
8753 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
8754 specified names. Synopsis:
8757 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
8760 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
8761 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
8762 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
8763 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
8765 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8770 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8773 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
8774 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8775 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
8776 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
8777 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
8784 @node mknod invocation
8785 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
8788 @cindex block special files, creating
8789 @cindex character special files, creating
8791 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
8792 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
8795 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
8798 @cindex special files
8799 @cindex block special files
8800 @cindex character special files
8801 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
8802 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
8803 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
8804 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
8805 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
8806 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
8807 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
8808 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
8810 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
8815 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
8819 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
8820 for a block special file
8823 @c Don't document the `u' option -- it's just a synonym for `c'.
8824 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
8826 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
8827 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
8828 for a character special file
8832 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
8833 device numbers must be given after the file type.
8834 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
8835 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
8836 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
8838 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8843 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8846 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8847 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
8848 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
8849 @xref{File permissions}.
8856 @node readlink invocation
8857 @section @command{readlink}: Print the referent of a symbolic link
8860 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
8862 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
8868 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic link.
8869 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
8870 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8872 @item Canonicalize mode
8874 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given file which contains
8875 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
8876 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
8881 readlink [@var{option}] @var{file}
8884 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
8886 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8891 @itemx --canonicalize
8893 @opindex --canonicalize
8894 Activate canonicalize mode.
8895 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
8896 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8899 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
8901 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
8902 Activate canonicalize mode.
8903 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
8904 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8907 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
8909 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
8910 Activate canonicalize mode.
8911 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
8917 @opindex --no-newline
8918 Do not output the trailing newline.
8928 Suppress most error messages.
8934 Report error messages.
8938 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
8943 @node rmdir invocation
8944 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
8947 @cindex removing empty directories
8948 @cindex directories, removing empty
8950 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
8953 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
8956 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
8957 directory, it is an error.
8959 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8963 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8964 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8965 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
8966 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
8967 the directory is non-empty.
8973 @cindex parent directories, removing
8974 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
8975 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
8976 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
8977 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
8978 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
8979 exit unsuccessfully.
8985 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
8986 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
8987 @var{directory} is removed.
8991 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
8996 @node unlink invocation
8997 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
9000 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
9002 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
9003 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
9004 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
9005 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
9006 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
9007 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
9010 unlink @var{filename}
9013 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
9014 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
9015 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
9017 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
9018 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
9019 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
9024 @node Changing file attributes
9025 @chapter Changing file attributes
9027 @cindex changing file attributes
9028 @cindex file attributes, changing
9029 @cindex attributes, file
9031 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
9032 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
9033 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
9034 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
9035 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
9038 These commands change file attributes.
9041 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
9042 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
9043 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
9044 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
9048 @node chown invocation
9049 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
9052 @cindex file ownership, changing
9053 @cindex group ownership, changing
9054 @cindex changing file ownership
9055 @cindex changing group ownership
9057 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
9058 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
9062 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9065 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
9066 (with no embedded white space):
9069 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
9076 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
9077 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
9080 @item owner@samp{:}group
9081 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
9082 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
9083 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
9086 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
9087 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
9088 @var{owner}'s login group.
9091 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
9092 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
9093 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
9096 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
9097 owner nor the group is changed.
9101 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
9102 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
9103 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
9105 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
9106 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
9107 require support for that, but for backward compatibility @acronym{GNU}
9108 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
9109 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
9110 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
9111 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
9114 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
9115 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
9116 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
9117 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
9118 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
9119 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
9120 privileges, or when the
9121 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
9123 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
9125 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9133 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
9134 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
9143 @cindex error messages, omitting
9144 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
9147 @itemx @w{@kbd{--from}=@var{old-owner}}
9149 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9150 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
9151 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
9153 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
9154 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
9155 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
9156 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
9159 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
9162 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
9163 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
9165 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
9169 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
9172 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
9173 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
9174 though still not perfect:
9177 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
9181 @opindex --dereference
9182 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9184 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9185 This is the default.
9188 @itemx --no-dereference
9190 @opindex --no-dereference
9191 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9193 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9194 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9195 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9196 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
9198 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9199 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9201 @itemx --preserve-root
9202 @opindex --preserve-root
9203 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9204 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9205 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9206 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9208 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9209 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9210 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9211 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9212 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9214 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9215 @opindex --reference
9216 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
9217 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9218 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
9225 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9226 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9227 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9228 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9229 its referent is being changed.
9234 @opindex --recursive
9235 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
9236 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
9239 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9242 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9245 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9254 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
9257 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
9260 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
9265 @node chgrp invocation
9266 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
9269 @cindex group ownership, changing
9270 @cindex changing group ownership
9272 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
9273 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
9274 or to the group of an existing reference file. Synopsis:
9277 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9280 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
9281 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
9282 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
9284 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9292 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
9293 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
9302 @cindex error messages, omitting
9303 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
9307 @opindex --dereference
9308 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9310 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9311 This is the default.
9314 @itemx --no-dereference
9316 @opindex --no-dereference
9317 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
9319 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9320 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9321 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9322 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
9324 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9325 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9327 @itemx --preserve-root
9328 @opindex --preserve-root
9329 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9330 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9331 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9332 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9334 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9335 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9336 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9337 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9338 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9340 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9341 @opindex --reference
9342 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
9343 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9344 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9350 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9351 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9352 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9353 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9354 its referent is being changed.
9359 @opindex --recursive
9360 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
9361 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
9364 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9367 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9370 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9379 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
9382 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
9387 @node chmod invocation
9388 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
9391 @cindex changing access permissions
9392 @cindex access permissions, changing
9393 @cindex permissions, changing access
9395 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
9398 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9401 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
9402 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
9403 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
9404 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
9405 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
9406 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
9407 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
9408 recursive directory traversals.
9410 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
9411 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
9412 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
9413 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
9414 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
9415 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
9416 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
9417 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
9419 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
9420 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
9421 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
9422 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
9423 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
9424 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
9425 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
9427 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9435 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
9444 @cindex error messages, omitting
9445 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
9448 @itemx --preserve-root
9449 @opindex --preserve-root
9450 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9451 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9452 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9453 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9455 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9456 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9457 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9458 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9459 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9465 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
9467 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9468 @opindex --reference
9469 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
9470 @xref{File permissions}.
9471 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
9472 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9477 @opindex --recursive
9478 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
9479 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
9486 @node touch invocation
9487 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
9490 @cindex changing file timestamps
9491 @cindex file timestamps, changing
9492 @cindex timestamps, changing file
9494 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
9495 specified files. Synopsis:
9498 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
9501 @cindex empty files, creating
9502 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty.
9504 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
9505 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
9508 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
9509 If changing both the access and modification times to the current
9510 time, @command{touch} can change the timestamps for files that the user
9511 running it does not own but has write permission for. Otherwise, the
9512 user must own the files.
9514 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
9515 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
9516 a third one as well: the inode change time. This is often referred to
9517 as a file's @code{ctime}.
9518 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
9519 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
9520 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
9521 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
9522 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
9523 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
9524 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
9525 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
9526 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
9527 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
9528 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
9531 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
9532 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
9533 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
9534 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9535 You can avoid ambiguities during
9536 daylight saving transitions by using @sc{utc} time stamps.
9538 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9544 @itemx --time=access
9548 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
9549 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
9550 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
9551 Change the access time only.
9556 @opindex --no-create
9557 Do not create files that do not exist.
9560 @itemx --date=@var{time}
9564 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
9565 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
9566 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
9567 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
9568 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
9569 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. @xref{Date input formats}.
9570 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
9571 silently ignore any excess precision here.
9575 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
9576 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
9580 @itemx --time=modify
9583 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
9584 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
9585 Change the modification time only.
9588 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
9590 @opindex --reference
9591 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
9592 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
9593 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
9594 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
9595 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
9596 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
9598 @item -t [[@var{CC}]@var{YY}]@var{MMDDhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
9599 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
9600 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
9601 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{CC}
9602 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
9603 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
9604 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
9608 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
9609 On older systems, @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
9610 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
9611 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
9612 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{MMDDhhmm}[@var{YY}]} and this
9613 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{YY}, if
9614 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
9615 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
9616 for the other files instead of as a file name.
9617 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
9618 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
9619 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
9620 behavior depends on this variable.
9621 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
9622 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
9632 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
9633 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
9634 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
9637 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
9638 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
9639 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
9640 * sync invocation:: Synchronize memory and disk.
9641 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
9646 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
9649 @cindex file system disk usage
9650 @cindex disk usage by file system
9652 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
9653 file systems. Synopsis:
9656 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9659 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
9660 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
9661 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
9663 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9664 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9665 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9667 @cindex disk device file
9668 @cindex device file, disk
9669 If an argument @var{file} is a disk device file containing a mounted
9670 file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that file system
9671 rather than on the file system containing the device node (i.e., the root
9672 file system). @sc{gnu} @command{df} does not attempt to determine the disk usage
9673 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
9674 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system
9677 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9685 @cindex automounter file systems
9686 @cindex ignore file systems
9687 Include in the listing dummy file systems, which
9688 are omitted by default. Such file systems are typically special-purpose
9689 pseudo-file-systems, such as automounter entries.
9692 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9694 @opindex --block-size
9695 @cindex file system sizes
9696 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9697 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9703 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
9710 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
9711 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
9712 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
9716 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
9717 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9718 (@pxref{Block size}).
9719 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9725 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9726 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
9731 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
9732 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
9733 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
9734 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
9735 out of date. This is the default.
9738 @itemx --portability
9740 @opindex --portability
9741 @cindex one-line output format
9742 @cindex @acronym{POSIX} output format
9743 @cindex portable output format
9744 @cindex output format, portable
9745 Use the @acronym{POSIX} output format. This is like the default format except
9750 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
9751 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
9752 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
9753 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
9756 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to @acronym{POSIX}.
9759 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
9760 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
9761 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
9762 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
9763 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
9770 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
9771 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
9772 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
9773 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
9774 there are many or very busy file systems.
9776 @item -t @var{fstype}
9777 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
9780 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9781 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
9782 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
9783 By default, nothing is omitted.
9788 @opindex --print-type
9789 @cindex file system types, printing
9790 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
9791 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
9792 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
9793 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
9798 @cindex @acronym{NFS} file system type
9799 An @acronym{NFS} file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
9800 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
9803 @item 4.2@r{, }ufs@r{, }efs@dots{}
9804 @cindex Linux file system types
9805 @cindex local file system types
9806 @opindex 4.2 @r{file system type}
9807 @opindex ufs @r{file system type}
9808 @opindex efs @r{file system type}
9809 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
9810 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
9812 @item hsfs@r{, }cdfs
9813 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
9814 @cindex High Sierra file system
9815 @opindex hsfs @r{file system type}
9816 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
9817 A file system on a CD-ROM drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
9818 systems use @samp{hsfs} (@samp{hs} for ``High Sierra'').
9821 @cindex PC file system
9822 @cindex DOS file system
9823 @cindex MS-DOS file system
9824 @cindex diskette file system
9826 An MS-DOS file system, usually on a diskette.
9830 @item -x @var{fstype}
9831 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
9833 @opindex --exclude-type
9834 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
9835 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
9836 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
9839 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
9844 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
9845 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
9846 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
9847 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
9851 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
9854 @cindex file space usage
9855 @cindex disk usage for files
9857 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the specified files
9858 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
9861 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9864 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
9865 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9866 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9867 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9869 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
9870 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
9871 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
9872 that @command{du} outputs.
9874 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9882 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
9884 @itemx --apparent-size
9885 @opindex --apparent-size
9886 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
9887 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
9888 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
9889 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
9890 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
9891 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
9892 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
9893 However, a sparse file created with this command:
9896 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
9900 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
9901 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
9907 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
9910 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9912 @opindex --block-size
9914 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9915 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9921 @cindex grand total of disk space
9922 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
9923 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
9924 a given set of files or directories.
9927 @itemx --dereference-args
9929 @opindex --dereference-args
9930 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
9931 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
9932 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
9933 are often symbolic links.
9935 @c --files0-from=FILE
9936 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
9942 Currently, @option{-H} is the same as @option{--si},
9943 except that @option{-H} evokes a warning.
9944 This option will be changed to be equivalent to
9945 @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
9949 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
9950 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9951 (@pxref{Block size}).
9952 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9955 @itemx --count-links
9957 @opindex --count-links
9958 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
9959 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
9963 @itemx --dereference
9965 @opindex --dereference
9966 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9967 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
9968 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
9973 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
9974 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9975 (@pxref{Block size}).
9976 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
9979 @itemx --no-dereference
9981 @opindex --no-dereference
9982 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9983 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
9984 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
9986 @item --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9987 @opindex --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9988 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
9989 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
9990 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
9991 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
9997 @cindex output null-byte-terminated lines
9998 Output a null byte at the end of each line, rather than a newline.
9999 This option enables other programs to parse the output of @command{du}
10000 even when that output would contain file names with embedded newlines.
10007 @opindex --summarize
10008 Display only a total for each argument.
10011 @itemx --separate-dirs
10013 @opindex --separate-dirs
10014 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
10015 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
10016 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
10017 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
10018 @var{d}, is merely the @code{stat.st_size}-derived size of the directory
10023 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
10024 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
10025 or any of its subdirectories.
10027 @itemx --time=ctime
10028 @itemx --time=status
10031 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
10032 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
10033 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
10034 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
10035 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
10037 @itemx --time=atime
10038 @itemx --time=access
10040 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
10041 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
10042 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
10043 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
10045 @item --time-style=@var{style}
10046 @opindex --time-style
10048 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
10049 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
10050 be one of the following:
10053 @item +@var{format}
10055 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
10056 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
10057 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
10058 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
10059 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
10060 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
10063 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
10064 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
10065 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
10066 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
10069 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
10070 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
10071 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
10072 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
10075 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
10076 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
10080 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
10081 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
10082 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
10083 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
10084 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
10085 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
10086 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
10089 @itemx --one-file-system
10091 @opindex --one-file-system
10092 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
10093 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
10094 the argument being processed is on.
10096 @item --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
10097 @opindex --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
10098 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
10099 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{PATTERN}.
10100 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
10103 @item -X @var{FILE}
10104 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
10105 @opindex -X @var{FILE}
10106 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
10107 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
10108 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{FILE},
10109 one per line. If @var{FILE} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
10114 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
10115 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
10116 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
10117 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
10118 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
10119 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
10124 @node stat invocation
10125 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
10128 @cindex file status
10129 @cindex file system status
10131 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
10134 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10137 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
10138 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
10139 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
10140 also give information about the files the links point to.
10146 @itemx --dereference
10148 @opindex --dereference
10149 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
10150 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
10151 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
10152 by each symbolic link argument.
10153 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
10156 @itemx --file-system
10158 @opindex --file-system
10159 @cindex file systems
10160 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
10161 instead of information about the files themselves.
10164 @itemx --format=@var{format}
10166 @opindex --format=@var{format}
10167 @cindex output format
10168 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
10169 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
10170 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
10171 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
10173 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
10178 @itemx --printf=@var{format}
10179 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
10180 @cindex output format
10181 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
10182 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
10183 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
10184 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
10185 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
10186 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
10188 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
10197 @cindex terse output
10198 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
10200 The valid format sequences for files are:
10203 @item %a - Access rights in octal
10204 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
10205 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
10206 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
10207 @item %d - Device number in decimal
10208 @item %D - Device number in hex
10209 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
10210 @item %F - File type
10211 @item %g - Group ID of owner
10212 @item %G - Group name of owner
10213 @item %h - Number of hard links
10214 @item %i - Inode number
10215 @item %n - File name
10216 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link
10217 @item %o - I/O block size
10218 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
10219 @item %t - Major device type in hex
10220 @item %T - Minor device type in hex
10221 @item %u - User ID of owner
10222 @item %U - User name of owner
10223 @item %x - Time of last access
10224 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
10225 @item %y - Time of last modification
10226 @item %Y - Time of last modification as seconds since Epoch
10227 @item %z - Time of last change
10228 @item %Z - Time of last change as seconds since Epoch
10231 The valid format sequences for file systems are:
10234 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
10235 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
10236 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
10237 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
10238 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
10239 @item %i - File System ID in hex
10240 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
10241 @item %n - File name
10242 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
10243 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
10244 @item %t - Type in hex
10245 @item %T - Type in human readable form
10249 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
10250 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
10251 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
10252 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10258 @node sync invocation
10259 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize data on disk with memory
10262 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
10264 @cindex superblock, writing
10265 @cindex inodes, written buffered
10266 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
10267 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
10268 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
10269 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync} system
10272 @cindex crashes and corruption
10273 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
10274 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
10275 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
10276 result. The @command{sync} command ensures everything in memory
10277 is written to disk.
10279 Any arguments are ignored, except for a lone @option{--help} or
10280 @option{--version} (@pxref{Common options}).
10285 @node truncate invocation
10286 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
10289 @cindex truncating, file sizes
10291 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
10292 specified size. Synopsis:
10295 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10298 @cindex files, creating
10299 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
10301 @cindex sparse files, creating
10302 @cindex holes, creating files with
10303 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
10304 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the extended part (or hole)
10305 reads as zero bytes.
10307 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10314 @opindex --no-create
10315 Do not create files that do not exist.
10320 @opindex --io-blocks
10321 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{FILE} rather than bytes.
10323 @item -r @var{rfile}
10324 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
10326 @opindex --reference
10327 Set the size of each @var{file} to the same size as @var{rfile}.
10329 @item -s @var{size}
10330 @itemx --size=@var{size}
10333 Set the size of each @var{file} to this @var{size}.
10334 @var{size} is a number which may be followed by one of these
10335 multiplicative suffixes:
10337 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
10338 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
10339 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
10340 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
10342 and so on for @samp{G}, @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
10344 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
10345 the size of each @var{file} based on their current size:
10347 @samp{+} => extend by
10348 @samp{-} => reduce by
10349 @samp{<} => at most
10350 @samp{>} => at least
10351 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
10352 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
10360 @node Printing text
10361 @chapter Printing text
10363 @cindex printing text, commands for
10364 @cindex commands for printing text
10366 This section describes commands that display text strings.
10369 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
10370 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
10371 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
10375 @node echo invocation
10376 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
10379 @cindex displaying text
10380 @cindex printing text
10381 @cindex text, displaying
10382 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
10384 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
10385 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
10388 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
10391 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10392 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
10393 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
10399 Do not output the trailing newline.
10403 @cindex backslash escapes
10404 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
10413 suppress trailing newline
10427 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10428 (zero to three octal digits)
10430 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10431 (one to three octal digits)
10433 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
10434 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
10439 @cindex backslash escapes
10440 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
10441 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
10442 specified, the last one given takes effect.
10446 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10447 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
10448 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
10449 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
10450 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
10451 plain @samp{hello}.
10453 @acronym{POSIX} does not require support for any options, and says
10454 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
10455 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
10456 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
10457 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
10458 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
10463 @node printf invocation
10464 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
10467 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
10470 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
10473 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
10474 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
10475 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
10476 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
10477 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
10478 The differences are as follows:
10483 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
10484 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
10488 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
10489 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
10490 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
10494 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
10495 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
10496 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
10499 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
10500 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
10501 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
10502 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
10507 @command{printf} has an additional directive, @samp{%b}, which prints its
10508 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
10509 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
10510 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits.
10511 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
10512 from the converted string.
10515 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
10516 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
10520 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10521 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
10522 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
10523 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
10524 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
10525 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
10526 @samp{97} on hosts that use the @acronym{ASCII} character set, since
10527 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in @acronym{ASCII}.
10532 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
10533 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
10534 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
10535 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
10536 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
10540 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
10541 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a character to print,
10542 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
10543 digits) specifying a character to print.
10548 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
10550 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
10551 @acronym{ISO} C 99:
10552 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (@acronym{ISO}/@acronym{IEC} 10646)
10553 characters, specified as
10554 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
10555 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
10556 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
10557 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the ranges
10558 U+0000...U+009F, U+D800...U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax, except
10559 for U+0024 ($), U+0040 (@@), and U+0060 (@`).
10561 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
10562 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
10563 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
10564 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
10566 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
10567 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
10568 Options must precede operands.
10570 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
10571 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
10574 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u20AC 14.95'
10578 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
10579 (@acronym{ISO}-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
10582 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
10586 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
10588 Note that in these examples, the full name of @command{printf} has been
10589 given, to distinguish it from the GNU @code{bash} built-in function
10592 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
10593 values of each character one by one. @acronym{ASCII} characters mixed with \u
10594 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
10595 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
10596 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
10597 this text in a locale-independent way:
10600 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
10601 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
10602 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
10603 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
10610 @node yes invocation
10611 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
10614 @cindex repeated output of a string
10616 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
10617 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
10618 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
10620 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
10622 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10623 To output an argument that begins with
10624 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
10625 @xref{Common options}.
10629 @chapter Conditions
10632 @cindex commands for exit status
10633 @cindex exit status commands
10635 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
10636 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
10637 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
10641 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
10642 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
10643 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
10644 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
10648 @node false invocation
10649 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
10652 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
10653 @cindex failure exit status
10654 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
10656 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
10657 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10658 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
10659 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
10660 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10661 command, not the one documented here.
10663 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10665 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10666 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10667 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10669 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
10670 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
10671 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10673 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
10674 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
10675 non-@acronym{GNU} hosts.
10678 @node true invocation
10679 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
10682 @cindex do nothing, successfully
10684 @cindex successful exit
10685 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
10687 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
10688 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10689 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
10690 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
10691 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
10692 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10693 command, not the one documented here.
10695 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10697 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
10698 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
10699 option, and with standard
10700 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
10701 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
10704 $ ./true --version >&-
10705 ./true: write error: Bad file number
10706 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
10707 ./true: write error: No space left on device
10710 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10711 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10712 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10714 @node test invocation
10715 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
10718 @cindex check file types
10719 @cindex compare values
10720 @cindex expression evaluation
10722 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
10723 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
10724 expression must be a separate argument.
10726 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
10727 comparison operators.
10729 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
10730 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
10731 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
10732 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
10733 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
10734 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
10740 test @var{expression}
10742 [ @var{expression} ]
10747 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
10748 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
10749 Because most shells have a built-in @command{test} command, using an
10750 unadorned @command{test} in a script or interactively may get you
10751 different functionality than that described here.
10753 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
10754 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
10755 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true otherwise. The argument
10756 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
10757 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
10758 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
10759 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
10760 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
10762 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
10766 0 if the expression is true,
10767 1 if the expression is false,
10768 2 if an error occurred.
10772 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
10773 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
10774 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
10775 * String tests:: -z -n = !=
10776 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
10777 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
10781 @node File type tests
10782 @subsection File type tests
10784 @cindex file type tests
10786 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
10787 but not all files are the same!)
10791 @item -b @var{file}
10793 @cindex block special check
10794 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
10796 @item -c @var{file}
10798 @cindex character special check
10799 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
10801 @item -d @var{file}
10803 @cindex directory check
10804 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
10806 @item -f @var{file}
10808 @cindex regular file check
10809 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
10811 @item -h @var{file}
10812 @itemx -L @var{file}
10815 @cindex symbolic link check
10816 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
10817 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
10818 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
10820 @item -p @var{file}
10822 @cindex named pipe check
10823 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
10825 @item -S @var{file}
10827 @cindex socket check
10828 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
10832 @cindex terminal check
10833 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
10839 @node Access permission tests
10840 @subsection Access permission tests
10842 @cindex access permission tests
10843 @cindex permission tests
10845 These options test for particular access permissions.
10849 @item -g @var{file}
10851 @cindex set-group-ID check
10852 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
10854 @item -k @var{file}
10856 @cindex sticky bit check
10857 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
10859 @item -r @var{file}
10861 @cindex readable file check
10862 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
10864 @item -u @var{file}
10866 @cindex set-user-ID check
10867 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
10869 @item -w @var{file}
10871 @cindex writable file check
10872 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
10874 @item -x @var{file}
10876 @cindex executable file check
10877 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
10878 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
10880 @item -O @var{file}
10882 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
10883 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
10885 @item -G @var{file}
10887 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
10888 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
10892 @node File characteristic tests
10893 @subsection File characteristic tests
10895 @cindex file characteristic tests
10897 These options test other file characteristics.
10901 @item -e @var{file}
10903 @cindex existence-of-file check
10904 True if @var{file} exists.
10906 @item -s @var{file}
10908 @cindex nonempty file check
10909 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
10911 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
10913 @cindex newer-than file check
10914 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
10915 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
10917 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
10919 @cindex older-than file check
10920 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
10921 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
10923 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
10925 @cindex same file check
10926 @cindex hard link check
10927 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
10928 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
10934 @subsection String tests
10936 @cindex string tests
10938 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
10939 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
10945 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
10946 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
10950 @item -z @var{string}
10952 @cindex zero-length string check
10953 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
10955 @item -n @var{string}
10956 @itemx @var{string}
10958 @cindex nonzero-length string check
10959 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
10961 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
10963 @cindex equal string check
10964 True if the strings are equal.
10966 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
10968 @cindex not-equal string check
10969 True if the strings are not equal.
10974 @node Numeric tests
10975 @subsection Numeric tests
10977 @cindex numeric tests
10978 @cindex arithmetic tests
10980 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
10981 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
10982 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
10986 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
10987 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
10988 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
10989 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
10990 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
10991 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
10998 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
10999 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
11000 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
11007 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
11009 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
11012 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
11016 @node Connectives for test
11017 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
11019 @cindex logical connectives
11020 @cindex connectives, logical
11022 The usual logical connectives.
11028 True if @var{expr} is false.
11030 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
11032 @cindex logical and operator
11033 @cindex and operator
11034 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
11036 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
11038 @cindex logical or operator
11039 @cindex or operator
11040 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
11045 @node expr invocation
11046 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
11049 @cindex expression evaluation
11050 @cindex evaluation of expressions
11052 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
11053 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
11055 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
11056 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
11057 @command{expr} converts
11058 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
11059 depending on the operation being applied to it.
11061 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
11062 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
11063 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
11064 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
11065 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
11066 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
11067 work around this is to use the @sc{gnu} extension @code{+},
11068 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
11069 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
11070 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
11072 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
11073 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
11074 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
11075 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
11076 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
11077 leading spaces as mentioned above.
11079 @cindex parentheses for grouping
11080 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
11081 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
11082 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
11085 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11086 options}. Options must precede operands.
11088 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
11092 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
11093 1 if the expression is null or 0,
11094 2 if the expression is invalid,
11095 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
11099 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
11100 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
11101 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
11102 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
11106 @node String expressions
11107 @subsection String expressions
11109 @cindex string expressions
11110 @cindex expressions, string
11112 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
11113 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
11114 the next sections).
11118 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
11119 @cindex pattern matching
11120 @cindex regular expression matching
11121 @cindex matching patterns
11122 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
11123 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
11124 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
11125 then matched against this regular expression.
11127 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
11128 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
11129 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
11131 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
11132 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
11134 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
11135 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
11136 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
11137 expression operators.
11139 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
11140 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
11141 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
11142 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
11143 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
11144 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
11145 characters. (@acronym{POSIX} allows either behavior.)
11146 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
11147 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
11149 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
11151 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
11152 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
11154 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
11156 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
11157 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
11158 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
11160 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
11162 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
11163 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
11164 @var{string}, return 0.
11166 @item length @var{string}
11168 Returns the length of @var{string}.
11170 @item + @var{token}
11172 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
11173 or an operator like @code{/}.
11174 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
11175 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
11176 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
11177 This operator is a @acronym{GNU} extension. Portable shell scripts should use
11178 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
11182 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
11183 @code{quote} operator.
11186 @node Numeric expressions
11187 @subsection Numeric expressions
11189 @cindex numeric expressions
11190 @cindex expressions, numeric
11192 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
11193 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
11194 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
11195 than the connectives (next section).
11203 @cindex subtraction
11204 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
11205 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
11211 @cindex multiplication
11214 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
11215 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
11220 @node Relations for expr
11221 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
11223 @cindex connectives, logical
11224 @cindex logical connectives
11225 @cindex relations, numeric or string
11227 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
11228 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
11229 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
11235 @cindex logical or operator
11236 @cindex or operator
11237 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
11238 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
11239 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
11244 @cindex logical and operator
11245 @cindex and operator
11246 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
11247 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
11250 @item < <= = == != >= >
11257 @cindex comparison operators
11259 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
11260 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
11261 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
11262 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
11263 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
11268 @node Examples of expr
11269 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
11271 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
11272 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
11274 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
11277 foo=`expr $foo + 1`
11280 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
11281 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
11284 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
11287 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
11295 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
11297 expr index abcdef cz
11300 @error{} expr: syntax error
11301 expr index quote index a
11307 @chapter Redirection
11309 @cindex redirection
11310 @cindex commands for redirection
11312 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
11313 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
11314 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
11315 it's described here.
11318 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
11322 @node tee invocation
11323 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
11326 @cindex pipe fitting
11327 @cindex destinations, multiple output
11328 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
11330 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
11331 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
11332 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
11335 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11338 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
11339 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
11340 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
11342 A @var{file} of @samp{-} causes @command{tee} to send another copy of
11343 input to standard output, but this is typically not that useful as the
11344 copies are interleaved.
11346 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11353 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
11357 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
11359 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
11360 Ignore interrupt signals.
11364 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
11365 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
11366 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
11367 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
11368 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
11371 wget http://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
11374 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
11375 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
11376 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
11377 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
11379 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
11380 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
11381 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
11384 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
11385 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11386 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
11389 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
11390 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
11391 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
11393 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
11394 called @dfn{process substitution}
11395 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
11396 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bashref,
11397 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
11398 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
11399 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
11400 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
11402 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
11403 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
11406 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11407 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
11410 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
11411 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
11412 process substitution is required:
11415 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
11416 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
11417 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
11421 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
11422 copy of the contents of a pipe.
11423 Consider a tool to graphically summarize disk usage data from @samp{du -ak}.
11424 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
11425 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
11426 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
11427 the uncompressed output.
11429 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
11430 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
11433 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
11434 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | xdiskusage -a
11437 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
11438 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
11441 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | xdiskusage -a
11444 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
11445 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
11446 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
11447 there may be a better way.
11448 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
11449 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
11450 (slightly simplified):
11453 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
11454 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
11455 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
11458 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
11459 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
11460 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
11461 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
11464 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
11465 tar chof - "$tardir" \
11466 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
11467 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
11473 @node File name manipulation
11474 @chapter File name manipulation
11476 @cindex file name manipulation
11477 @cindex manipulation of file names
11478 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
11480 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
11483 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
11484 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name.
11485 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability.
11489 @node basename invocation
11490 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
11493 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
11494 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
11495 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
11496 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
11497 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
11499 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
11500 @var{name}. Synopsis:
11503 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
11506 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
11507 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
11508 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
11509 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
11512 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
11513 @macro basenameAndDirname
11514 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
11515 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
11516 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
11517 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
11519 @basenameAndDirname
11521 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11522 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, @acronym{GNU}
11523 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
11524 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11525 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11527 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11528 options}. Options must precede operands.
11536 basename /usr/bin/sort
11539 basename include/stdio.h .h
11543 @node dirname invocation
11544 @section @command{dirname}: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
11547 @cindex directory components, printing
11548 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
11549 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
11551 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component of
11552 a string (presumably a file name). Synopsis:
11558 If @var{name} is a single component, @command{dirname} prints @samp{.}
11559 (meaning the current directory).
11561 @basenameAndDirname
11563 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11564 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With @acronym{GNU} @command{dirname}, the
11565 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11566 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11568 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11576 # Output "/usr/bin".
11577 dirname /usr/bin/sort
11584 @node pathchk invocation
11585 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name portability
11588 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
11589 @cindex valid file names, checking for
11590 @cindex portable file names, checking for
11592 @command{pathchk} checks portability of file names. Synopsis:
11595 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
11598 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints a message if any of
11599 these conditions is true:
11603 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
11604 (execute) permission,
11606 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
11609 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
11610 its file system's maximum.
11613 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
11614 name could be created under the above conditions.
11616 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11617 Options must precede operands.
11623 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
11624 print a message if any of these conditions is true:
11628 A file name is empty.
11631 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
11632 @acronym{POSIX} minimum limits for portability.
11635 A file name contains a character outside the portable file name
11636 character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{-},
11637 @samp{.}, @samp{/}, and @samp{_}.
11642 Print a message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
11643 that begins with @samp{-}.
11645 @item --portability
11646 @opindex --portability
11647 Print a message if a file name is not portable to all @acronym{POSIX}
11648 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
11652 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
11656 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
11661 @node Working context
11662 @chapter Working context
11664 @cindex working context
11665 @cindex commands for printing the working context
11667 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
11668 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
11669 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
11672 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
11673 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
11674 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
11675 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
11679 @node pwd invocation
11680 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
11683 @cindex print name of current directory
11684 @cindex current working directory, printing
11685 @cindex working directory, printing
11687 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
11688 @command{pwd} prints the fully resolved name of the current directory.
11689 That is, all components of the printed name will be actual directory
11690 names---none will be symbolic links.
11692 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
11693 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
11694 Because most shells have a built-in @command{pwd} command, using an
11695 unadorned @command{pwd} in a script or interactively may get you
11696 different functionality than that described here.
11698 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
11699 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
11704 @node stty invocation
11705 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
11708 @cindex change or print terminal settings
11709 @cindex terminal settings
11710 @cindex line settings of terminal
11712 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
11716 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
11717 stty [@var{option}]
11720 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
11721 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
11722 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
11723 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
11724 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
11725 @option{--file} option.
11727 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
11728 the terminal line operation, as described below.
11730 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11737 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
11738 be used in combination with any line settings.
11740 @item -F @var{device}
11741 @itemx --file=@var{device}
11744 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
11745 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
11746 because opening a @acronym{POSIX} tty requires use of the @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to
11747 prevent a @acronym{POSIX} tty from blocking until the carrier detect line is high if
11748 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
11749 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
11755 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
11756 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
11757 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
11758 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
11762 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
11763 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
11764 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
11765 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
11768 Some settings are not available on all @acronym{POSIX} systems, since they use
11769 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with ``Non-@acronym{POSIX}'' in their
11770 description. On non-@acronym{POSIX} systems, those or other settings also may not
11771 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
11777 * Control:: Control settings
11778 * Input:: Input settings
11779 * Output:: Output settings
11780 * Local:: Local settings
11781 * Combination:: Combination settings
11782 * Characters:: Special characters
11783 * Special:: Special settings
11788 @subsection Control settings
11790 @cindex control settings
11796 @cindex two-way parity
11797 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
11803 @cindex even parity
11804 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
11811 @cindex character size
11812 @cindex eight-bit characters
11813 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
11818 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
11824 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
11828 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
11832 @cindex modem control
11833 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
11837 @cindex hardware flow control
11838 @cindex flow control, hardware
11839 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
11840 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11845 @subsection Input settings
11847 @cindex input settings
11852 @cindex breaks, ignoring
11853 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
11857 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
11858 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
11862 @cindex parity, ignoring
11863 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
11867 @cindex parity errors, marking
11868 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
11872 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
11876 @cindex eight-bit input
11877 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
11881 @cindex newline, translating to return
11882 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
11886 @cindex return, ignoring
11887 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
11891 @cindex return, translating to newline
11892 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
11896 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
11897 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
11901 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
11902 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
11903 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{CTRL-S}/@kbd{CTRL-Q}). May
11910 @cindex software flow control
11911 @cindex flow control, software
11912 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
11913 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
11914 empty again. May be negated.
11918 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
11919 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11924 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
11925 if negated). Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11929 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
11930 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
11931 when the input buffer is full. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11936 @subsection Output settings
11938 @cindex output settings
11939 These arguments specify output-related operations.
11944 Postprocess output. May be negated.
11948 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
11949 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11954 @cindex return, translating to newline
11955 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11959 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
11960 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11965 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11970 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11974 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
11975 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11980 @cindex pad character
11981 Use delete characters for fill instead of null characters. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11987 Newline delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11994 Carriage return delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12000 @opindex tab@var{n}
12001 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12006 Backspace delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12011 Vertical tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12016 Form feed delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12021 @subsection Local settings
12023 @cindex local settings
12028 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
12029 characters. May be negated.
12033 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
12034 special characters. May be negated.
12038 Enable non-@acronym{POSIX} special characters. May be negated.
12042 Echo input characters. May be negated.
12048 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
12053 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
12054 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
12058 @cindex newline, echoing
12059 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
12063 @cindex flushing, disabling
12064 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
12065 characters. May be negated.
12069 @cindex case translation
12070 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
12071 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
12072 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12076 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
12077 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12084 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
12085 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12091 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
12092 @cindex hat notation for control characters
12093 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
12094 of literally. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12100 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
12101 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
12102 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12108 @subsection Combination settings
12110 @cindex combination settings
12111 Combination settings:
12118 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
12119 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
12123 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
12124 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
12128 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
12129 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
12133 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
12140 @c This is too long to write inline.
12142 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl -ixoff
12143 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel opost -olcuc -ocrnl onlcr
12144 -onocr -onlret -ofill -ofdel nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0
12145 ff0 isig icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl
12146 -noflsh -xcase -tostop -echoprt echoctl echoke
12150 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
12154 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
12155 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
12156 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
12157 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
12164 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
12165 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -iuclc -ixany
12166 -imaxbel -opost -isig -icanon -xcase min 1 time 0
12170 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
12174 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
12179 @cindex eight-bit characters
12180 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
12181 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
12185 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
12186 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
12190 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12194 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated. If negated, same
12201 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
12205 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
12209 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
12214 @subsection Special characters
12216 @cindex special characters
12217 @cindex characters, special
12219 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
12220 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
12221 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
12222 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
12223 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
12224 any other digit to indicate decimal.
12226 @cindex disabling special characters
12227 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
12228 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
12229 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
12230 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
12231 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
12232 special character to @key{U}.)
12238 Send an interrupt signal.
12242 Send a quit signal.
12246 Erase the last character typed.
12250 Erase the current line.
12254 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
12262 Alternate character to end the line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12266 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12270 Restart the output after stopping it.
12278 Send a terminal stop signal.
12282 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12286 Redraw the current line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12290 Erase the last word typed. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12294 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
12295 character. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12300 @subsection Special settings
12302 @cindex special settings
12307 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
12308 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
12312 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
12313 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
12315 @item ispeed @var{n}
12317 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
12319 @item ospeed @var{n}
12321 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
12325 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12328 @itemx columns @var{n}
12331 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12337 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
12338 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
12339 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
12340 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
12341 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12345 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
12349 Print the terminal speed.
12352 @cindex baud rate, setting
12353 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one of: 0
12354 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600 19200
12355 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as 19200;
12356 @code{extb} is the same as 38400. Many systems, including GNU/Linux,
12357 support higher speeds. The @command{stty} command includes support
12374 4000000 where the system supports these.
12375 0 hangs up the line if @option{-clocal} is set.
12379 @node printenv invocation
12380 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
12383 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
12384 @cindex environment variables, printing
12386 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
12389 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
12392 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
12393 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
12394 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
12396 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12397 @xref{Common options}.
12399 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
12403 0 if all variables specified were found
12404 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
12405 2 if a write error occurred
12409 @node tty invocation
12410 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
12413 @cindex print terminal file name
12414 @cindex terminal file name, printing
12416 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
12417 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
12421 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
12424 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12434 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
12438 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
12442 0 if standard input is a terminal
12443 1 if standard input is not a terminal
12444 2 if given incorrect arguments
12445 3 if a write error occurs
12449 @node User information
12450 @chapter User information
12452 @cindex user information, commands for
12453 @cindex commands for printing user information
12455 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
12456 logins, groups, and so forth.
12459 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
12460 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
12461 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
12462 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
12463 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
12464 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
12468 @node id invocation
12469 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
12472 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
12473 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
12474 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
12476 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
12477 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
12480 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{username}]
12483 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
12484 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
12485 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
12487 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
12488 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
12490 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
12491 Also see @ref{Common options}.
12498 Print only the group ID.
12504 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
12510 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
12511 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12517 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID. Requires
12518 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12524 Print only the user ID.
12530 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
12531 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
12532 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
12533 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
12534 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
12535 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
12536 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
12538 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
12540 @node logname invocation
12541 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
12544 @cindex printing user's login name
12545 @cindex login name, printing
12546 @cindex user name, printing
12549 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
12550 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12551 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
12552 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
12553 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
12555 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12561 @node whoami invocation
12562 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
12565 @cindex effective user ID, printing
12566 @cindex printing the effective user ID
12568 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
12569 effective user ID. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
12571 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12577 @node groups invocation
12578 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
12581 @cindex printing groups a user is in
12582 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
12584 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
12585 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
12586 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
12588 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
12589 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
12592 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
12595 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
12597 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
12599 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12605 @node users invocation
12606 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
12609 @cindex printing current usernames
12610 @cindex usernames, printing current
12612 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
12613 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
12614 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
12615 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
12616 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
12625 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
12626 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12627 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
12628 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
12630 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12636 @node who invocation
12637 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
12640 @cindex printing current user information
12641 @cindex information, about current users
12643 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
12647 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
12650 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
12652 @cindex remote hostname
12653 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
12654 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
12655 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
12659 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
12660 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12661 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
12662 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
12663 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
12667 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
12668 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
12669 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
12670 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
12673 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
12674 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
12675 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
12676 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
12678 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12686 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
12692 Print the date and time of last system boot.
12698 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
12704 Print column headings.
12708 Same as @samp{who am i}.
12714 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
12715 Overrides all other options.
12719 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
12724 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
12725 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
12726 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
12732 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
12733 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
12737 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
12738 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
12739 automatic dial-up internet access.
12745 Print a line of column headings.
12751 List active processes spawned by init.
12756 @opindex --runlevel
12757 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
12763 Print last system clock change.
12774 @opindex --writable
12775 @cindex message status
12776 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
12777 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
12780 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
12781 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
12782 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
12790 @node System context
12791 @chapter System context
12793 @cindex system context
12794 @cindex context, system
12795 @cindex commands for system context
12797 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
12801 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
12802 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
12803 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
12804 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
12805 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
12806 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
12810 @node date invocation
12811 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
12814 @cindex time, printing or setting
12815 @cindex printing the current time
12820 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
12821 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
12822 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
12826 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
12827 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
12828 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
12829 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
12832 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
12833 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
12834 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
12835 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
12837 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
12838 @cindex time formats
12839 @cindex formatting times
12840 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
12841 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
12842 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
12843 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
12844 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
12845 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
12851 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
12852 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
12853 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
12854 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
12855 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
12856 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
12858 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
12860 * Examples of date:: Examples.
12863 @node Time conversion specifiers
12864 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
12866 @cindex time conversion specifiers
12867 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
12869 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
12873 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
12875 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12877 hour (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}).
12878 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12880 hour (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}).
12881 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12883 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
12885 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
12886 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12888 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
12889 blank in many locales.
12890 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
12892 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
12893 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12895 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
12897 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
12898 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12900 @cindex epoch, seconds since
12901 @cindex seconds since the epoch
12902 @cindex beginning of time
12903 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC.
12904 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
12905 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
12906 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12908 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
12909 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
12911 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
12913 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
12915 @w{@acronym{RFC} 2822/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone
12916 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
12917 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
12918 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
12919 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
12920 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
12921 by the @option{--date} option.
12922 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12924 @w{@acronym{RFC} 3339/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone with
12925 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
12926 zone is determinable.
12927 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12929 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
12930 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
12932 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12934 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
12935 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
12936 no time zone is determinable.
12937 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12939 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
12940 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
12944 @node Date conversion specifiers
12945 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
12947 @cindex date conversion specifiers
12948 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
12950 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
12954 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
12956 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
12958 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
12960 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
12962 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
12964 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
12965 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
12966 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
12967 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
12969 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
12971 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
12973 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
12975 full date in @acronym{ISO} 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
12976 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
12977 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
12979 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12981 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number, but without the century
12982 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
12983 as @samp{%y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO} week number (see
12985 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
12986 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12988 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number. This has the
12989 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO}
12991 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
12993 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
12994 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
12995 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
12996 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
13000 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
13002 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
13004 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
13006 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
13007 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
13008 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
13010 @acronym{ISO} week number, that is, the
13011 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
13012 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
13013 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
13014 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
13015 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the @acronym{ISO} 8601
13018 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
13020 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
13021 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
13022 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
13024 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
13026 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
13028 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
13029 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
13030 precedes year @samp{0000}.
13034 @node Literal conversion specifiers
13035 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
13037 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
13038 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
13040 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
13052 @node Padding and other flags
13053 @subsection Padding and other flags
13055 @cindex numeric field padding
13056 @cindex padding of numeric fields
13057 @cindex fields, padding numeric
13059 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
13060 with zeros, so that, for
13061 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
13062 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
13063 since there is no natural width for them.
13065 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
13066 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
13070 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
13073 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
13074 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
13076 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
13077 would normally pad with spaces.
13079 Use upper case characters if possible.
13081 Use opposite case characters if possible.
13082 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
13086 Here are some examples of padding:
13089 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
13091 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
13093 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
13097 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, you can specify the field width
13098 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
13099 output is of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
13100 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
13101 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
13102 a field of width 9.
13104 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
13105 specification. The modifiers are:
13109 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
13110 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
13111 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
13112 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
13116 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
13117 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
13120 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
13121 is available, it is ignored.
13124 @node Setting the time
13125 @subsection Setting the time
13127 @cindex setting the time
13128 @cindex time setting
13129 @cindex appropriate privileges
13131 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
13132 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
13133 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
13134 system clock. The @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be
13135 used with such an argument. The @option{--universal} option may be used
13136 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
13137 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time
13140 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
13153 first two digits of year (optional)
13155 last two digits of year (optional)
13160 The @option{--set} option also sets the system clock; see the next section.
13163 @node Options for date
13164 @subsection Options for @command{date}
13166 @cindex @command{date} options
13167 @cindex options for @command{date}
13169 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13173 @item -d @var{datestr}
13174 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
13177 @cindex parsing date strings
13178 @cindex date strings, parsing
13179 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
13182 @opindex next @var{day}
13183 @opindex last @var{day}
13184 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
13185 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
13186 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
13187 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
13188 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
13189 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
13190 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}.@*
13191 @xref{Date input formats}.
13193 @item -f @var{datefile}
13194 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
13197 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
13198 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
13199 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
13200 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
13203 @item -r @var{file}
13204 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
13206 @opindex --reference
13207 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
13208 instead of the current date and time.
13215 @opindex --rfc-2822
13216 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
13217 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
13221 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
13224 This format conforms to
13225 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
13226 @acronym{RFCs} 2822} and
13227 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
13228 current and previous standards for Internet email.
13230 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
13231 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
13232 Display the date using a format specified by
13233 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
13234 @acronym{RFC} 3339}. This is a subset of the @acronym{ISO} 8601
13235 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
13236 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times. Unlike the other
13237 standard formats, @acronym{RFC} 3339 format is always suitable as
13238 input for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
13239 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
13241 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
13242 It can be one of the following:
13246 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
13247 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
13250 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
13251 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
13252 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
13253 hours and thirty minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. This is equivalent to
13254 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
13257 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
13258 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
13259 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
13263 @item -s @var{datestr}
13264 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
13267 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
13274 @opindex --universal
13275 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
13277 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
13280 Use Coordinated Universal Time (@acronym{UTC}) by operating as if the
13281 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
13283 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (@sc{gmt}) for
13284 historical reasons.
13288 @node Examples of date
13289 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
13291 @cindex examples of @command{date}
13293 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
13294 option in the previous section.
13299 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
13302 date --date='2 days ago'
13306 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
13309 date --date='3 months 1 day'
13313 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
13316 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
13320 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
13326 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
13327 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
13328 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
13331 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
13332 of the month, you can use the (@acronym{GNU} extension)
13333 @samp{-} flag to suppress
13334 the padding altogether:
13337 date -d 1may '+%B %-d
13341 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
13342 non-@acronym{GNU} versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
13345 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
13349 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
13352 date --set='+2 minutes'
13356 To print the date in @acronym{RFC} 2822 format,
13357 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
13360 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
13363 @anchor{%s-examples}
13365 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
13366 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
13367 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
13368 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
13369 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
13373 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
13377 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
13378 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
13379 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
13380 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
13381 seconds) behind UTC:
13384 # local time zone used
13385 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
13390 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
13391 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
13392 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
13393 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
13396 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
13400 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
13401 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
13402 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
13403 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
13404 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
13407 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
13411 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
13412 a more readable form, use a command like this:
13415 # local time zone used
13416 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
13417 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
13420 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
13421 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
13424 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
13425 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
13428 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
13431 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
13432 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
13438 @node arch invocation
13439 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
13442 @cindex print machine hardware name
13443 @cindex system information, printing
13445 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
13446 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
13450 arch [@var{option}]
13453 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
13458 @node uname invocation
13459 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
13462 @cindex print system information
13463 @cindex system information, printing
13465 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
13466 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
13467 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
13470 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
13473 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
13474 printed in this order:
13477 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
13478 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
13481 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
13482 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
13483 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
13487 @result{} Linux dum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
13491 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13499 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
13500 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
13503 @itemx --hardware-platform
13505 @opindex --hardware-platform
13506 @cindex implementation, hardware
13507 @cindex hardware platform
13508 @cindex platform, hardware
13509 Print the hardware platform name
13510 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
13511 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13512 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13518 @cindex machine type
13519 @cindex hardware class
13520 @cindex hardware type
13521 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
13527 @opindex --nodename
13530 @cindex network node name
13531 Print the network node hostname.
13536 @opindex --processor
13537 @cindex host processor type
13538 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
13539 architecture or ISA).
13540 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13541 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13544 @itemx --operating-system
13546 @opindex --operating-system
13547 @cindex operating system name
13548 Print the name of the operating system.
13551 @itemx --kernel-release
13553 @opindex --kernel-release
13554 @cindex kernel release
13555 @cindex release of kernel
13556 Print the kernel release.
13559 @itemx --kernel-name
13561 @opindex --kernel-name
13562 @cindex kernel name
13563 @cindex name of kernel
13564 Print the kernel name.
13565 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
13566 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
13567 @acronym{POSIX} specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
13568 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
13569 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
13570 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
13571 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
13575 @itemx --kernel-version
13577 @opindex --kernel-version
13578 @cindex kernel version
13579 @cindex version of kernel
13580 Print the kernel version.
13587 @node hostname invocation
13588 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
13591 @cindex setting the hostname
13592 @cindex printing the hostname
13593 @cindex system name, printing
13594 @cindex appropriate privileges
13596 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
13597 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
13598 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
13602 hostname [@var{name}]
13605 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13611 @node hostid invocation
13612 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier.
13615 @cindex printing the host identifier
13617 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
13618 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
13619 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
13620 @xref{Common options}.
13622 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
13629 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
13630 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
13635 @node uptime invocation
13636 @section @command{uptime}: Print system uptime and load
13639 @cindex printing the system uptime and load
13641 @command{uptime} prints the current time, the system's uptime, the
13642 number of logged-in users and the current load average.
13644 If an argument is specified, it is used as the file to be read
13645 to discover how many users are logged in. If no argument is
13646 specified, a system default is used (@command{uptime --help} indicates
13647 the default setting).
13649 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
13650 @xref{Common options}.
13652 For example, here's what it prints right now on one system I use:
13656 14:07 up 3:35, 3 users, load average: 1.39, 1.15, 1.04
13659 The precise method of calculation of load average varies somewhat
13660 between systems. Some systems calculate it as the average number of
13661 runnable processes over the last 1, 5 and 15 minutes, but some systems
13662 also include processes in the uninterruptible sleep state (that is,
13663 those processes which are waiting for disk I/O). The Linux kernel
13664 includes uninterruptible processes.
13666 @node Modified command invocation
13667 @chapter Modified command invocation
13669 @cindex modified command invocation
13670 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
13671 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
13673 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
13674 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
13678 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
13679 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
13680 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
13681 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
13682 * su invocation:: Modify user and group ID.
13683 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
13687 @node chroot invocation
13688 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
13691 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
13692 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
13694 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
13695 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
13696 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
13697 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
13698 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
13699 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.}
13703 chroot @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13704 chroot @var{option}
13707 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
13708 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
13709 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist) and then runs
13710 @var{command} with optional @var{args}. If @var{command} is not
13711 specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL} environment
13712 variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the @option{-i} option.
13713 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
13714 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13716 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13717 options}. Options must precede operands.
13719 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
13720 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
13721 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
13722 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
13723 your new root directory.
13725 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
13726 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
13729 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
13732 Then you'll see output like this:
13737 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
13740 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
13741 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
13742 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
13743 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
13744 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
13745 device files), copy them into place, too.
13747 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
13751 1 if @command{chroot} itself fails
13752 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13753 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13754 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13758 @node env invocation
13759 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
13762 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
13763 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
13764 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
13766 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
13769 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
13770 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13774 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
13775 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
13776 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
13777 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
13778 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
13779 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
13781 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
13782 characters other than @samp{=} and the null character (@acronym{ASCII}
13783 @sc{nul}). However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
13784 consist solely of underscores, digits, and @acronym{ASCII} letters,
13785 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
13786 work well with other names.
13789 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
13790 specifies the program to invoke; it is
13791 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
13792 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
13793 The program should not be a special built-in utility
13794 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13796 @cindex environment, printing
13798 If no command name is specified following the environment
13799 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
13800 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
13802 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13803 Options must precede operands.
13807 @item -u @var{name}
13808 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
13811 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
13816 @itemx --ignore-environment
13819 @opindex --ignore-environment
13820 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
13824 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
13828 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
13829 1 if @command{env} itself fails
13830 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13831 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13832 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13836 @node nice invocation
13837 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
13841 @cindex scheduling, affecting
13842 @cindex appropriate privileges
13844 @command{nice} prints or modifies a process's @dfn{niceness},
13845 a parameter that affects whether the process is scheduled favorably.
13849 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13852 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
13853 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
13854 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
13856 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
13857 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
13858 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
13859 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
13860 may have a wider range of nicenesses; conversely, other systems may
13861 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
13862 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
13863 minimum or maximum supported value.
13865 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
13866 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
13867 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
13868 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
13869 terminology, @acronym{POSIX} defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
13870 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the nonnegative difference
13871 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
13872 conforms to @acronym{POSIX}, its documentation and diagnostics use the
13873 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
13875 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13876 built-in utilities}).
13878 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
13879 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
13880 Because many shells have a built-in @command{nice} command, using an
13881 unadorned @command{nice} in a script or interactively may get you
13882 different functionality than that described here.
13884 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13885 Options must precede operands.
13888 @item -n @var{adjustment}
13889 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
13891 @opindex --adjustment
13892 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
13893 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
13894 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
13897 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
13898 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
13899 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
13903 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
13907 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
13908 1 if @command{nice} itself fails
13909 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13910 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13911 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13914 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
13917 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
13920 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
13921 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
13923 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
13934 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
13935 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
13936 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
13940 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
13944 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
13945 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
13948 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
13952 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
13956 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
13958 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
13963 @node nohup invocation
13964 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
13967 @cindex hangups, immunity to
13968 @cindex immunity to hangups
13969 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
13972 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
13973 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
13977 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
13980 If standard input is a terminal, it is redirected from
13981 @file{/dev/null} so that terminal sessions do not mistakenly consider
13982 the terminal to be used by the command. This is a @acronym{GNU}
13983 extension; programs intended to be portable to non-@acronym{GNU} hosts
13984 should use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{} </dev/null}
13988 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
13989 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
13990 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
13991 command is not run.
13992 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
13993 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
13994 regardless of the current umask settings.
13996 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
13997 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
13998 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
13999 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
14000 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
14002 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
14003 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
14007 nohup make > make.log
14010 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
14011 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
14012 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
14013 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
14014 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
14016 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
14017 built-in utilities}).
14019 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14020 options}. Options must precede operands.
14022 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
14026 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
14027 127 if @command{nohup} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
14028 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
14032 @node su invocation
14033 @section @command{su}: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
14036 @cindex substitute user and group IDs
14037 @cindex user ID, switching
14038 @cindex super-user, becoming
14039 @cindex root, becoming
14041 @command{su} allows one user to temporarily become another user. It runs a
14042 command (often an interactive shell) with the real and effective user
14043 ID, group ID, and supplemental groups of a given @var{user}. Synopsis:
14046 su [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
14049 @cindex passwd entry, and @command{su} shell
14051 @flindex /etc/passwd
14052 If no @var{user} is given, the default is @code{root}, the super-user.
14053 The shell to use is taken from @var{user}'s @code{passwd} entry, or
14054 @file{/bin/sh} if none is specified there. If @var{user} has a
14055 password, @command{su} prompts for the password unless run by a user with
14056 effective user ID of zero (the super-user).
14062 @cindex login shell
14063 By default, @command{su} does not change the current directory.
14064 It sets the environment variables @env{HOME} and @env{SHELL}
14065 from the password entry for @var{user}, and if @var{user} is not
14066 the super-user, sets @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME} to @var{user}.
14067 By default, the shell is not a login shell.
14069 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
14072 @cindex @option{-su}
14073 GNU @command{su} does not treat @file{/bin/sh} or any other shells specially
14074 (e.g., by setting @code{argv[0]} to @option{-su}, passing @option{-c} only
14075 to certain shells, etc.).
14078 @command{su} can optionally be compiled to use @code{syslog} to report
14079 failed, and optionally successful, @command{su} attempts. (If the system
14080 supports @code{syslog}.) However, GNU @command{su} does not check if the
14081 user is a member of the @code{wheel} group; see below.
14083 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14086 @item -c @var{command}
14087 @itemx --command=@var{command}
14090 Pass @var{command}, a single command line to run, to the shell with
14091 a @option{-c} option instead of starting an interactive shell.
14098 @cindex file name pattern expansion, disabled
14099 @cindex globbing, disabled
14100 Pass the @option{-f} option to the shell. This probably only makes sense
14101 if the shell run is @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}, for which the @option{-f}
14102 option prevents reading the startup file (@file{.cshrc}). With
14103 Bourne-like shells, the @option{-f} option disables file name pattern
14104 expansion (globbing), which is not likely to be useful.
14112 @c other variables already indexed above
14115 @cindex login shell, creating
14116 Make the shell a login shell. This means the following. Unset all
14117 environment variables except @env{TERM}, @env{HOME}, and @env{SHELL}
14118 (which are set as described above), and @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME}
14119 (which are set, even for the super-user, as described above), and set
14120 @env{PATH} to a compiled-in default value. Change to @var{user}'s home
14121 directory. Prepend @samp{-} to the shell's name, intended to make it
14122 read its login startup file(s).
14126 @itemx --preserve-environment
14129 @opindex --preserve-environment
14130 @cindex environment, preserving
14131 @flindex /etc/shells
14132 @cindex restricted shell
14133 Do not change the environment variables @env{HOME}, @env{USER},
14134 @env{LOGNAME}, or @env{SHELL}. Run the shell given in the environment
14135 variable @env{SHELL} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd
14136 entry, unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and
14137 @var{user}'s shell is restricted. A @dfn{restricted shell} is one that
14138 is not listed in the file @file{/etc/shells}, or in a compiled-in list
14139 if that file does not exist. Parts of what this option does can be
14140 overridden by @option{--login} and @option{--shell}.
14142 @item -s @var{shell}
14143 @itemx --shell=@var{shell}
14146 Run @var{shell} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd entry,
14147 unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and @var{user}'s
14148 shell is restricted (see @option{-m} just above).
14152 @cindex exit status of @command{su}
14156 1 if @command{su} itself fails
14157 126 if subshell is found but cannot be invoked
14158 127 if subshell cannot be found
14159 the exit status of the subshell otherwise
14162 @cindex wheel group, not supported
14163 @cindex group wheel, not supported
14165 @subsection Why GNU @command{su} does not support the @samp{wheel} group
14167 (This section is by Richard Stallman.)
14171 Sometimes a few of the users try to hold total power over all the
14172 rest. For example, in 1984, a few users at the MIT AI lab decided to
14173 seize power by changing the operator password on the Twenex system and
14174 keeping it secret from everyone else. (I was able to thwart this coup
14175 and give power back to the users by patching the kernel, but I
14176 wouldn't know how to do that in Unix.)
14178 However, occasionally the rulers do tell someone. Under the usual
14179 @command{su} mechanism, once someone learns the root password who
14180 sympathizes with the ordinary users, he or she can tell the rest. The
14181 ``wheel group'' feature would make this impossible, and thus cement the
14182 power of the rulers.
14184 I'm on the side of the masses, not that of the rulers. If you are
14185 used to supporting the bosses and sysadmins in whatever they do, you
14186 might find this idea strange at first.
14189 @node timeout invocation
14190 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
14194 @cindex run commands with bounded time
14196 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
14197 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
14200 timeout [@var{option}] @var{number}[smhd] @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
14204 @var{number} is an integer followed by an optional unit; the default
14205 is seconds. The units are:
14218 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
14219 built-in utilities}).
14221 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14222 Options must precede operands.
14225 @item -s @var{signal}
14226 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
14229 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
14230 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
14231 or a number. Also see @xref{Signal specifications}.
14235 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
14239 124 if @var{command} times out
14240 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
14241 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
14242 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
14243 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
14247 @node Process control
14248 @chapter Process control
14250 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
14251 @cindex commands for controlling processes
14254 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
14258 @node kill invocation
14259 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
14262 @cindex send a signal to processes
14264 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
14265 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
14266 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
14269 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
14270 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
14273 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
14274 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
14275 is @samp{TERM}. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
14276 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
14277 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
14279 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
14280 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
14281 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
14282 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
14283 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
14284 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
14285 value of @var{pid}.
14287 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
14288 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
14291 If a negative @var{PID} argument is desired as the first one, it
14292 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
14293 @acronym{POSIX}, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
14294 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
14303 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
14304 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
14306 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
14307 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
14308 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
14309 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
14310 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
14311 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
14312 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
14313 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
14314 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
14315 and if there is no output error.
14317 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
14318 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
14320 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
14321 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
14322 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
14323 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
14324 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
14325 ambiguity with lower case option letters. For a list of supported
14326 signal names and numbers see @xref{Signal specifications}.
14331 @cindex delaying commands
14332 @cindex commands for delaying
14334 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
14337 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
14341 @node sleep invocation
14342 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
14345 @cindex delay for a specified time
14347 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
14348 the values of the command line arguments.
14352 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
14356 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
14357 is seconds. The units are:
14370 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
14371 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
14372 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
14373 arbitrary floating point numbers (using a period before any fractional
14376 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14382 @node Numeric operations
14383 @chapter Numeric operations
14385 @cindex numeric operations
14386 These programs do numerically-related operations.
14389 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
14390 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
14394 @node factor invocation
14395 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
14398 @cindex prime factors
14400 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
14403 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
14404 factor @var{option}
14407 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
14408 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
14410 The @command{factor} command supports only a small number of options:
14414 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
14418 Forces the use of the GNU MP library. By default, @command{factor}
14419 selects between using GNU MP and using native operations on the basis
14420 of the length of the number to be factored.
14423 Forces the use of native operations instead of GNU MP. This causes
14424 @command{factor} to fail for larger inputs.
14427 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
14431 Factoring the product of the eighth and ninth Mersenne primes
14432 takes about 30 milliseconds of CPU time on a 2.2 GHz Athlon.
14435 M8=`echo 2^31-1|bc` ; M9=`echo 2^61-1|bc`
14436 /usr/bin/time -f '%U' factor $(echo "$M8 * $M9" | bc)
14437 4951760154835678088235319297: 2147483647 2305843009213693951
14441 Similarly, factoring the eighth Fermat number @math{2^{256}+1} takes
14442 about 20 seconds on the same machine.
14444 Factoring large prime numbers is, in general, hard. The Pollard Rho
14445 algorithm used by @command{factor} is particularly effective for
14446 numbers with relatively small factors. If you wish to factor large
14447 numbers which do not have small factors (for example, numbers which
14448 are the product of two large primes), other methods are far better.
14450 If @command{factor} is built without using GNU MP, only
14451 single-precision arithmetic is available, and so large numbers
14452 (typically @math{2^{64}} and above) will not be supported. The single-precision
14453 code uses an algorithm which is designed for factoring smaller
14459 @node seq invocation
14460 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
14463 @cindex numeric sequences
14464 @cindex sequence of numbers
14466 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
14469 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
14470 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
14471 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
14474 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
14475 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
14476 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
14477 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
14478 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
14479 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
14480 Floating-point numbers
14481 may be specified (using a period before any fractional digits).
14483 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14484 Options must precede operands.
14487 @item -f @var{format}
14488 @itemx --format=@var{format}
14489 @opindex -f @var{format}
14490 @opindex --format=@var{format}
14491 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
14492 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
14493 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
14494 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
14495 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}.
14496 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
14497 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
14498 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
14499 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
14500 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
14501 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
14503 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
14504 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
14505 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
14506 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
14507 the default format is @samp{%g}.
14509 @item -s @var{string}
14510 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
14511 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
14512 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
14513 The output always terminates with a newline.
14516 @itemx --equal-width
14517 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
14518 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
14519 decimal representation.
14520 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
14524 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
14527 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
14533 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
14534 to perform the conversion:
14537 $ printf '%x\n' `seq 1048575 1024 1050623`
14543 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
14544 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
14547 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
14553 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
14556 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
14557 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
14558 differ depending on your floating-point implementation, but a common
14559 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
14560 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
14563 $ seq 18446744073709551616 1 18446744073709551618
14564 18446744073709551616
14565 18446744073709551616
14566 18446744073709551618
14569 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
14570 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
14571 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
14572 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
14575 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
14578 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
14583 @node File permissions
14584 @chapter File permissions
14587 @include getdate.texi
14591 @node Opening the software toolbox
14592 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
14594 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
14595 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
14596 @cite{What's GNU?} column of @cite{Linux Journal}, 2 (June, 1994)}.
14597 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
14600 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
14601 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
14602 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
14603 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
14604 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
14605 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
14606 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
14610 @node Toolbox introduction
14611 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
14613 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
14614 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system and how they
14615 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
14616 of program development and usage.
14618 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
14619 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
14620 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
14621 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
14622 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
14623 for solving many kinds of problems.
14625 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
14626 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
14627 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
14628 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
14629 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
14631 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
14632 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
14633 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
14634 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
14635 with the handle of his screwdriver.
14637 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
14638 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
14639 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
14644 difficult to write,
14647 difficult to maintain and
14651 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
14654 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
14655 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
14656 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
14658 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
14659 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
14660 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
14661 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
14662 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
14663 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
14664 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
14665 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
14666 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
14668 @node I/O redirection
14669 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
14671 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
14672 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
14673 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
14674 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
14675 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
14676 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
14677 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
14678 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
14679 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
14682 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
14685 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
14688 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
14689 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
14690 it is in the desired form.
14692 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
14693 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
14694 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
14695 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
14696 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
14697 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
14698 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
14699 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
14700 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
14702 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
14703 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
14704 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
14705 lines delimited by the @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed) character,
14706 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
14707 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
14708 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
14709 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
14710 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
14711 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
14712 data with a text editor.)
14714 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
14715 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
14716 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
14717 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
14718 for the full story.
14720 @node The who command
14721 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
14723 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
14724 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
14725 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
14730 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
14731 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
14732 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
14733 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
14736 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
14737 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
14738 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
14739 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
14740 but the data is not all that exciting.
14742 @node The cut command
14743 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
14745 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
14746 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
14747 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
14748 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
14752 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
14755 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
14758 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
14759 @print{} root:Operator
14761 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
14762 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
14766 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
14767 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
14768 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
14769 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
14771 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
14782 @node The sort command
14783 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
14785 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
14786 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
14787 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
14790 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
14791 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
14792 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
14793 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
14794 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
14797 @node The uniq command
14798 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
14800 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
14801 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
14802 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
14803 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
14804 standard input. It prints only one
14805 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
14806 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
14807 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
14810 @node Putting the tools together
14811 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
14813 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
14814 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a program that will
14815 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
14816 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
14819 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
14820 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
14821 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
14822 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
14823 by generating just a list of logged on users:
14833 Next, sort the list:
14836 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
14843 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
14846 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14852 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
14853 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
14854 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
14856 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it available for
14857 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
14858 or @code{root}, prompt):
14861 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
14862 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14864 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
14867 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
14868 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
14869 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
14870 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
14871 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
14872 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
14873 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
14876 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
14877 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
14878 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
14880 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
14881 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
14882 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
14884 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
14885 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
14886 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
14889 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
14890 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
14892 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
14893 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
14894 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
14898 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
14899 @print{} this example has mixed case!
14902 There are several options of interest:
14906 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
14907 operations apply to characters not in the given set
14910 delete characters in the first set from the output
14913 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
14916 We will be using all three options in a moment.
14918 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
14919 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
14920 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
14921 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
14922 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
14923 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
14924 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
14946 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
14947 instead of a regular file.
14949 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
14950 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
14953 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
14954 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
14957 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
14960 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
14961 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
14965 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
14968 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
14969 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
14970 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
14971 be left alone. (The @acronym{ASCII} tab character should also be included for
14972 good measure in a production script.)
14974 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
14975 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
14976 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
14977 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
14980 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14981 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
14984 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
14985 multiple newline characters in the output into just one. This helps us
14986 avoid blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
14987 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
14988 typing in all of a command.)
14990 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
14991 case. We're ready to count each word:
14994 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14995 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
14998 At this point, the data might look something like this:
15011 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
15012 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
15013 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
15017 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
15020 reverse the order of the sort
15023 The final pipeline looks like this:
15026 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
15027 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
15036 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
15037 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
15038 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
15039 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
15041 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
15042 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
15043 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
15044 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
15045 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
15046 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
15047 revision of this article.}
15048 this is a is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
15050 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
15051 a sorted list of words, one per line:
15054 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
15055 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
15058 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
15059 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
15062 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
15063 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
15064 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
15067 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
15068 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
15069 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
15070 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
15071 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
15072 spelling checker on Unix.
15074 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
15078 search files for text that matches a regular expression
15081 count lines, words, characters
15084 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
15087 the stream editor, an advanced tool
15090 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
15093 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
15094 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
15095 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
15096 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
15102 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
15105 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
15106 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
15107 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
15110 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
15111 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
15114 Let someone else do the hard part.
15117 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
15118 appropriate tool, build one.
15121 As of this writing, all the programs we've discussed are available via
15122 anonymous @command{ftp} from: @*
15123 @uref{ftp://gnudist.gnu.org/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz}. (There may
15124 be more recent versions available now.)
15126 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
15127 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
15128 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
15129 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
15130 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
15131 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
15132 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
15133 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
15134 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
15137 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
15138 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
15139 still in print and are well worth
15140 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
15141 how I view programming.
15143 The programs in both books are available from
15144 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
15145 For a number of years, there was an active
15146 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
15147 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
15148 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
15149 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
15151 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
15152 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
15153 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
15154 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
15155 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
15157 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
15158 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
15160 @node GNU Free Documentation License
15161 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
15165 @node Concept index
15174 @c Local variables:
15175 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32